Cleanup of window coordinate positioning code.
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000,
4 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
5 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
7 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
8
9 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26 #include <signal.h>
27 #include <stdio.h>
28 #include <setjmp.h>
29
30 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
31
32 #include "lisp.h"
33 #include "blockinput.h"
34
35 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
36 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
37 #include "syssignal.h"
38
39 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
40 if this is not done before the other system files. */
41 #include "xterm.h"
42 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
43
44 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
45 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
46 #ifndef makedev
47 #include <sys/types.h>
48 #endif /* makedev */
49
50 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_IOCTL_H
51 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
52 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_SYS_IOCTL_H) */
53
54 #include "systime.h"
55
56 #include <fcntl.h>
57 #include <ctype.h>
58 #include <errno.h>
59 #include <setjmp.h>
60 #include <sys/stat.h>
61 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
62 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
63
64 #include "charset.h"
65 #include "character.h"
66 #include "coding.h"
67 #include "frame.h"
68 #include "dispextern.h"
69 #include "fontset.h"
70 #include "termhooks.h"
71 #include "termopts.h"
72 #include "termchar.h"
73 #include "emacs-icon.h"
74 #include "disptab.h"
75 #include "buffer.h"
76 #include "window.h"
77 #include "keyboard.h"
78 #include "intervals.h"
79 #include "process.h"
80 #include "atimer.h"
81 #include "keymap.h"
82 #include "font.h"
83 #include "fontset.h"
84 #include "xsettings.h"
85 #include "xgselect.h"
86 #include "sysselect.h"
87
88 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
89 #include <X11/Shell.h>
90 #endif
91
92 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
93 #include <sys/time.h>
94 #endif
95 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
96 #include <unistd.h>
97 #endif
98
99 #ifdef USE_GTK
100 #include "gtkutil.h"
101 #endif
102
103 #ifdef USE_LUCID
104 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
105 #endif
106
107 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
108 #if !defined(NO_EDITRES)
109 #define HACK_EDITRES
110 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
111 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
112
113 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
114
115 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
116 #if defined USE_MOTIF
117 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
118 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
119 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
120
121 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
122 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
123 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
124 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
125 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
126 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
127 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
128 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
129 #ifndef XtNpickTop
130 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
131 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
132 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
133 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
134
135 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
136
137 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
138 #include "widget.h"
139 #ifndef XtNinitialState
140 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
141 #endif
142 #endif
143
144 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
145 #ifdef USE_XIM
146 int use_xim = 1;
147 #else
148 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
149 #endif
150
151 \f
152
153 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
154
155 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
156
157 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
158 start. */
159
160 static int any_help_event_p;
161
162 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
163 static Lisp_Object last_window;
164
165 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
166
167 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
168
169 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
170
171 int x_underline_at_descent_line;
172
173 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
174 use. */
175
176 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
177
178 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
179 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
180 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
181 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
182
183 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
184
185 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
186 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
187 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
188 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
189
190 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
191
192 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
193
194 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
195
196 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
197
198 static struct {
199 struct frame *f;
200 int eventtype;
201 } pending_event_wait;
202
203 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
204 /* The application context for Xt use. */
205 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
206 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
207 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
208
209 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
210
211 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
212
213 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
214 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
215
216 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
217
218 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
219 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
220 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
221
222 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
223
224 /* Mouse movement.
225
226 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
227 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
228 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
229 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
230
231 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
232
233 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
234 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
235 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
236 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
237 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
238 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
239 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
240 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
241 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
242 is off. */
243
244 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
245
246 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
247 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
248 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
249
250 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
251
252 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
253 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
254 an ordinary motion.
255
256 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
257 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
258 event. */
259
260 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
261
262 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
263 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
264 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
265 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
266 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
267 it's somewhat accurate. */
268
269 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
270
271 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
272
273 static Time last_user_time;
274
275 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
276 events. */
277
278 #ifdef __STDC__
279 static int volatile input_signal_count;
280 #else
281 static int input_signal_count;
282 #endif
283
284 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
285
286 static int x_noop_count;
287
288 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
289
290 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
291 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
292 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
293
294 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
295 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
296
297 #ifdef USE_GTK
298 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
299 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
300
301 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
302 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
303 #endif
304
305 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
306 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
307
308 /* Used in x_flush. */
309
310 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources (Display *, const char *, const char *,
311 const char *);
312 extern int x_bitmap_mask (FRAME_PTR, int);
313
314 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
315 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
316 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
317 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
318
319 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
320 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
321 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
322 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
323 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
324 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
325 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
326 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
327 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
328 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
329 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
330 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
331 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
332 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
333 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
334 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
335 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
336 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
337 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
338 enum text_cursor_kinds);
339
340 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
341 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
342 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
343 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
344 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
345 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
346 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
347 enum scroll_bar_part *,
348 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
349 unsigned long *);
350 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
351 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
352 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
353 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
354 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
355 int *, struct input_event *);
356 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
357 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
358 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
359
360
361 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
362
363 static void
364 x_flush (struct frame *f)
365 {
366 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
367 connection may be broken. */
368 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
369 return;
370
371 BLOCK_INPUT;
372 if (f == NULL)
373 {
374 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
375 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
376 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
377 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
378 }
379 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
380 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
381 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
382 }
383
384
385 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
386 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
387 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
388 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
389 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
390 performance. */
391
392 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
393
394 \f
395 /***********************************************************************
396 Debugging
397 ***********************************************************************/
398
399 #if 0
400
401 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
402 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
403
404 struct record
405 {
406 char *locus;
407 int type;
408 };
409
410 struct record event_record[100];
411
412 int event_record_index;
413
414 record_event (locus, type)
415 char *locus;
416 int type;
417 {
418 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
419 event_record_index = 0;
420
421 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
422 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
423 event_record_index++;
424 }
425
426 #endif /* 0 */
427
428
429 \f
430 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
431
432 struct x_display_info *
433 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
434 {
435 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
436
437 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
438 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
439 return dpyinfo;
440
441 return 0;
442 }
443
444 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
445
446 void
447 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
448 {
449 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
450 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
451 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
452 double alpha = 1.0;
453 double alpha_min = 1.0;
454 unsigned long opac;
455
456 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window != FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc)
457 /* Since the WM decoration lies under the FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW,
458 we must treat the former instead of the latter. */
459 win = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
460
461 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
462 alpha = f->alpha[0];
463 else
464 alpha = f->alpha[1];
465
466 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
467 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
468 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
469 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
470
471 if (alpha < 0.0)
472 return;
473 else if (alpha > 1.0)
474 alpha = 1.0;
475 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
476 alpha = alpha_min;
477
478 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
479
480 /* return unless necessary */
481 {
482 unsigned char *data;
483 Atom actual;
484 int rc, format;
485 unsigned long n, left;
486
487 x_catch_errors (dpy);
488 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
489 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
490 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
491 &data);
492
493 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
494 if (*(unsigned long *)data == opac)
495 {
496 XFree ((void *) data);
497 x_uncatch_errors ();
498 return;
499 }
500 else
501 XFree ((void *) data);
502 x_uncatch_errors ();
503 }
504
505 x_catch_errors (dpy);
506 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
507 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
508 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
509 x_uncatch_errors ();
510 }
511
512 int
513 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
514 {
515 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
516 }
517
518 int
519 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
520 {
521 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
522 }
523
524 \f
525 /***********************************************************************
526 Starting and ending an update
527 ***********************************************************************/
528
529 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
530 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
531 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
532 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
533 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
534
535 static void
536 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
537 {
538 /* Nothing to do. */
539 }
540
541
542 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
543 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
544 position of W. */
545
546 static void
547 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
548 {
549 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
550 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
551
552 updated_window = w;
553 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
554
555 BLOCK_INPUT;
556
557 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
558 {
559 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
560 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
561
562 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
563 highlighting. */
564 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
565 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
566 }
567
568 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
569 }
570
571
572 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
573
574 static void
575 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
576 {
577 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
578 struct face *face;
579
580 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
581 if (face)
582 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
583 face->foreground);
584
585 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
586 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
587 }
588
589 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
590
591 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
592 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
593
594 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
595 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
596 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
597
598 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
599 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
600 here. */
601
602 static void
603 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
604 {
605 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
606
607 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
608 {
609 BLOCK_INPUT;
610
611 if (cursor_on_p)
612 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
613 output_cursor.vpos,
614 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
615
616 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
617 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
618
619 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
620 }
621
622 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
623 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
624 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
625 {
626 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
627 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
628 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
629 }
630
631 updated_window = NULL;
632 }
633
634
635 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
636 update_end. */
637
638 static void
639 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
640 {
641 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
642 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
643
644 #ifndef XFlush
645 BLOCK_INPUT;
646 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
647 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
648 #endif
649 }
650
651
652 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
653 complete update has been performed. The global variable
654 updated_window is not available here. */
655
656 static void
657 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
658 {
659 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
660 {
661 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
662
663 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
664 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
665 {
666 BLOCK_INPUT;
667 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
668 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
669 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
670 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
671 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
672 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
673 }
674 }
675 }
676
677
678 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
679 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
680 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
681 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
682 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
683 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
684
685 static void
686 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
687 {
688 struct window *w = updated_window;
689 struct frame *f;
690 int width, height;
691
692 xassert (w);
693
694 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
695 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
696
697 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
698 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
699 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
700 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
701 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
702 overhead is very small. */
703 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
704 && desired_row->full_width_p
705 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
706 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
707 width != 0)
708 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
709 height > 0))
710 {
711 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
712
713 BLOCK_INPUT;
714 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
715 0, y, width, height, False);
716 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
717 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
718 y, width, height, False);
719 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
720 }
721 }
722
723 static void
724 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
725 {
726 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
727 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
728 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
729 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
730 struct face *face = p->face;
731
732 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
733 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
734
735 if (!p->overlay_p)
736 {
737 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
738
739 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
740 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
741 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
742 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
743 if (face->stipple)
744 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
745 else
746 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
747
748 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
749 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
750 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
751 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
752 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
753 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
754 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
755 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
756 {
757 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
758
759 if (sb_width > 0)
760 {
761 int left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
762 int width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
763 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
764
765 if (bx < 0)
766 {
767 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
768 if (left + width == p->x)
769 bx = left + sb_width;
770 else if (p->x + p->wd == left)
771 bx = left;
772 if (bx >= 0)
773 {
774 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
775
776 nx = width - sb_width;
777 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
778 row->y));
779 ny = row->visible_height;
780 }
781 }
782 else
783 {
784 if (left + width == bx)
785 {
786 bx = left + sb_width;
787 nx += width - sb_width;
788 }
789 else if (bx + nx == left)
790 nx += width - sb_width;
791 }
792 }
793 }
794 #endif
795 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
796 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
797
798 if (!face->stipple)
799 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
800 }
801
802 if (p->which)
803 {
804 unsigned char *bits;
805 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
806 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
807 XGCValues gcv;
808
809 if (p->wd > 8)
810 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
811 else
812 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
813
814 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
815 by the server. */
816 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
817 (p->cursor_p
818 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
819 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
820 : face->foreground),
821 face->background, depth);
822
823 if (p->overlay_p)
824 {
825 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
826 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
827 bits, p->wd, p->h,
828 1, 0, 1);
829 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
830 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
831 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
832 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
833 }
834
835 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
836 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
837 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
838
839 if (p->overlay_p)
840 {
841 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
842 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
843 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
844 }
845 }
846
847 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
848 }
849
850 \f
851
852 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
853 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
854 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
855 rarely happens). */
856
857 static void
858 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
859 {
860 }
861
862 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
863 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
864
865 static void
866 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
867 {
868 }
869
870 \f
871 /***********************************************************************
872 Glyph display
873 ***********************************************************************/
874
875
876
877 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
878 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
880 int);
881 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
882 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
883 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
884 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
885 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
886 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
887 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
888 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
889 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
890 unsigned long *, double, int);
891 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
892 double, int, unsigned long);
893 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
894 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
895 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
897 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
898 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
899 int, int, int);
900 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
901 int, int, int, int, int, int,
902 XRectangle *);
903 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
904 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
905
906 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
907 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
908 #endif
909
910
911 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
912 face. */
913
914 static void
915 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
916 {
917 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
918 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
919 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
920 && !s->cmp)
921 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
922 else
923 {
924 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
925 XGCValues xgcv;
926 unsigned long mask;
927
928 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
929 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
930
931 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
932 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
933 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
934 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
935 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
936 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
937 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
938
939 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
940 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
941 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
942 {
943 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
944 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
945 }
946
947 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
948 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
949 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
950
951 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
952 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
953 mask, &xgcv);
954 else
955 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
956 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
957
958 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
959 }
960 }
961
962
963 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
964
965 static void
966 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
967 {
968 int face_id;
969 struct face *face;
970
971 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
972 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
973 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
974 if (face == NULL)
975 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
976
977 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
978 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
979 else
980 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
981 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
982 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
983
984 if (s->font == s->face->font)
985 s->gc = s->face->gc;
986 else
987 {
988 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
989 except for FONT. */
990 XGCValues xgcv;
991 unsigned long mask;
992
993 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
994 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
995 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
996 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
997
998 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
999 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1000 mask, &xgcv);
1001 else
1002 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1003 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1004
1005 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1006
1007 }
1008 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1009 }
1010
1011
1012 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1013 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1014 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1015
1016 static INLINE void
1017 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1018 {
1019 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1020 }
1021
1022
1023 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1024 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1025 pattern. */
1026
1027 static INLINE void
1028 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1029 {
1030 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1031
1032 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1033 {
1034 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1035 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1036 }
1037 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1038 {
1039 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1040 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1041 }
1042 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1043 {
1044 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1045 s->stippled_p = 0;
1046 }
1047 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1048 {
1049 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1050 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1051 }
1052 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1053 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1054 {
1055 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1056 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1057 }
1058 else
1059 {
1060 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1061 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1062 }
1063
1064 /* GC must have been set. */
1065 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1066 }
1067
1068
1069 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1070 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1071
1072 static INLINE void
1073 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1074 {
1075 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1076 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1077
1078 if (n > 0)
1079 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1080 s->num_clips = n;
1081 }
1082
1083
1084 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1085 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1086 the area of SRC. */
1087
1088 static void
1089 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1090 {
1091 XRectangle r;
1092
1093 r.x = src->x;
1094 r.width = src->width;
1095 r.y = src->y;
1096 r.height = src->height;
1097 dst->clip[0] = r;
1098 dst->num_clips = 1;
1099 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1100 }
1101
1102
1103 /* RIF:
1104 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1105
1106 static void
1107 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1108 {
1109 if (s->cmp == NULL
1110 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1111 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1112 {
1113 struct font_metrics metrics;
1114
1115 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1116 {
1117 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1118 struct font *font = s->font;
1119 int i;
1120
1121 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1122 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1123 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1124 }
1125 else
1126 {
1127 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1128
1129 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1130 }
1131 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1132 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1133 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1134 }
1135 else if (s->cmp)
1136 {
1137 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1138 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1139 }
1140 }
1141
1142
1143 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1144
1145 static INLINE void
1146 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1147 {
1148 XGCValues xgcv;
1149 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1150 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1151 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1152 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1153 }
1154
1155
1156 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1157 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1158 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1159 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1160 contains the first component of a composition. */
1161
1162 static void
1163 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1164 {
1165 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1166 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1167 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1168 {
1169 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1170
1171 if (s->stippled_p)
1172 {
1173 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1174 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1175 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1176 s->y + box_line_width,
1177 s->background_width,
1178 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1179 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1180 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1181 }
1182 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1183 || s->font_not_found_p
1184 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1185 || force_p)
1186 {
1187 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1188 s->background_width,
1189 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1190 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1191 }
1192 }
1193 }
1194
1195
1196 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1197
1198 static void
1199 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1200 {
1201 int i, x;
1202
1203 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1204 of S to the right of that box line. */
1205 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1206 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1207 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1208 else
1209 x = s->x;
1210
1211 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1212 loaded. */
1213 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1214 {
1215 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1216 {
1217 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1218 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1219 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1220 s->height - 1);
1221 x += g->pixel_width;
1222 }
1223 }
1224 else
1225 {
1226 struct font *font = s->font;
1227 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1228 int y;
1229
1230 if (font->vertical_centering)
1231 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1232
1233 y = s->ybase - boff;
1234 if (s->for_overlaps
1235 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1236 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1237 else
1238 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1239 if (s->face->overstrike)
1240 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1241 }
1242 }
1243
1244 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1245
1246 static void
1247 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1248 {
1249 int i, j, x;
1250 struct font *font = s->font;
1251
1252 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1253 of S to the right of that box line. */
1254 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1255 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1256 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1257 else
1258 x = s->x;
1259
1260 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1261 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1262 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1263 this composition. */
1264
1265 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1266 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1267 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1268 {
1269 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1270 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1271 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1272 }
1273 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1274 {
1275 int y = s->ybase;
1276
1277 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1278 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1279 {
1280 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1281 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1282
1283 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1284 if (s->face->overstrike)
1285 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1286 }
1287 }
1288 else
1289 {
1290 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1291 Lisp_Object glyph;
1292 int y = s->ybase;
1293 int width = 0;
1294
1295 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1296 {
1297 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1298 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1299 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1300 else
1301 {
1302 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1303
1304 if (j < i)
1305 {
1306 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1307 if (s->face->overstrike)
1308 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1309 x += width;
1310 }
1311 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1312 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1313 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1314 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1315 if (s->face->overstrike)
1316 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1317 x += wadjust;
1318 j = i + 1;
1319 width = 0;
1320 }
1321 }
1322 if (j < i)
1323 {
1324 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1325 if (s->face->overstrike)
1326 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1327 }
1328 }
1329 }
1330
1331
1332 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1333
1334 static void
1335 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1336 {
1337 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1338 XChar2b char2b[8];
1339 int x, i, j;
1340
1341 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1342 of S to the right of that box line. */
1343 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1344 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1345 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1346 else
1347 x = s->x;
1348
1349 s->char2b = char2b;
1350
1351 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1352 {
1353 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1354 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1355
1356 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1357 {
1358 if (len > 0
1359 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1360 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1361 >= 1))
1362 {
1363 Lisp_Object acronym
1364 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1365 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1366 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1367 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1368 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1369 str = (char *) SDATA (acronym);
1370 }
1371 }
1372 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1373 {
1374 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1375 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1376 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1377 str = buf;
1378 }
1379
1380 if (str)
1381 {
1382 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1383 unsigned code;
1384
1385 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1386 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1387 {
1388 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1389 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1390 }
1391 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1392 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1393 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1394 0);
1395 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1396 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1397 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1398 0);
1399 }
1400 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1401 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1402 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1403 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1404 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1405 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1406 }
1407 }
1408
1409 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1410
1411 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1412 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1413 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1414 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1415 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1416
1417
1418 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1419 cannot be determined. */
1420
1421 static struct frame *
1422 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1423 {
1424 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1425 Lisp_Object tail;
1426 struct frame *f;
1427
1428 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1429
1430 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1431 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1432 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1433 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1434 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1435 widget = XtParent (widget);
1436
1437 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1438 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1439 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1440 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1441 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1442 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1443 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1444 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1445 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1446 return f;
1447
1448 abort ();
1449 }
1450
1451
1452 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1453 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1454 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1455 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1456
1457 int
1458 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1459 {
1460 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1461 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1462 }
1463
1464
1465 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1466 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1467 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1468 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1469 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1470 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1471
1472 int
1473 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1474 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1475 {
1476 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1477 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1478 }
1479
1480
1481 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1482 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1483
1484 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1485 {
1486 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1487 sizeof (Screen *)},
1488 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1489 sizeof (Colormap)}
1490 };
1491
1492
1493 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1494 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1495
1496 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1497
1498
1499 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1500
1501 DPY is the display we are working on.
1502
1503 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1504 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1505 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1506 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1507
1508 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1509 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1510
1511 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1512 we allocated the color or not.
1513
1514 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1515
1516 static Boolean
1517 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1518 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1519 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1520 {
1521 Screen *screen;
1522 Colormap cmap;
1523 Pixel pixel;
1524 String color_name;
1525 XColor color;
1526
1527 if (*nargs != 2)
1528 {
1529 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1530 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1531 "XtToolkitError",
1532 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1533 return False;
1534 }
1535
1536 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1537 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1538 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1539
1540 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1541 {
1542 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1543 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1544 }
1545 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1546 {
1547 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1548 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1549 }
1550 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1551 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1552 {
1553 pixel = color.pixel;
1554 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1555 }
1556 else
1557 {
1558 String params[1];
1559 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1560
1561 params[0] = color_name;
1562 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1563 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1564 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1565 params, &nparams);
1566 return False;
1567 }
1568
1569 if (to->addr != NULL)
1570 {
1571 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1572 {
1573 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1574 return False;
1575 }
1576
1577 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1578 }
1579 else
1580 {
1581 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1582 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1583 }
1584
1585 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1586 return True;
1587 }
1588
1589
1590 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1591 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1592 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1593
1594 APP is the application context in which we work.
1595
1596 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1597 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1598 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1599
1600 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1601
1602 static void
1603 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1604 Cardinal *nargs)
1605 {
1606 if (*nargs != 2)
1607 {
1608 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1609 "XtToolkitError",
1610 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1611 NULL, NULL);
1612 }
1613 else if (closure != NULL)
1614 {
1615 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1616 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1617 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1618 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1619 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1620 }
1621 }
1622
1623
1624 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1625
1626
1627 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1628 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1629 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1630 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1631
1632 static const XColor *
1633 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1634 {
1635 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1636
1637 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1638 {
1639 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1640 int i;
1641
1642 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1643 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1644 dpyinfo->color_cells
1645 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1646 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1647
1648 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1649 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1650
1651 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1652 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1653 }
1654
1655 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1656 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1657 }
1658
1659
1660 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1661 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1662
1663 void
1664 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1665 {
1666 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1667
1668 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1669 {
1670 int i;
1671 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1672 {
1673 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1674 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1675 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1676 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1677 }
1678 }
1679 else
1680 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1681 }
1682
1683
1684 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1685 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1686
1687 void
1688 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1689 {
1690 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1691 }
1692
1693
1694 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1695 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1696 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1697 allocated. */
1698
1699 static int
1700 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1701 {
1702 int rc;
1703
1704 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1705 if (rc == 0)
1706 {
1707 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1708 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1709 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1710 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1711 int nearest, i;
1712 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1713 int ncells;
1714 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1715
1716 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1717 {
1718 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1719 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1720 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1721 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1722
1723 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1724 {
1725 nearest = i;
1726 nearest_delta = delta;
1727 }
1728 }
1729
1730 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1731 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1732 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1733 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1734 }
1735 else
1736 {
1737 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1738 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1739 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1740 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1741 XColor *cached_color;
1742
1743 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1744 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1745 (cached_color->red != color->red
1746 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1747 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1748 {
1749 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1750 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1751 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1752 }
1753 }
1754
1755 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1756 if (rc)
1757 register_color (color->pixel);
1758 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1759
1760 return rc;
1761 }
1762
1763
1764 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1765 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1766 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1767 allocated. */
1768
1769 int
1770 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1771 {
1772 gamma_correct (f, color);
1773 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1774 }
1775
1776
1777 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1778 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1779 get color reference counts right. */
1780
1781 unsigned long
1782 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1783 {
1784 XColor color;
1785
1786 color.pixel = pixel;
1787 BLOCK_INPUT;
1788 x_query_color (f, &color);
1789 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1790 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1791 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1792 register_color (pixel);
1793 #endif
1794 return color.pixel;
1795 }
1796
1797
1798 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1799 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1800 get color reference counts right. */
1801
1802 unsigned long
1803 x_copy_dpy_color (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int pixel)
1804 {
1805 XColor color;
1806
1807 color.pixel = pixel;
1808 BLOCK_INPUT;
1809 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1810 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1811 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1812 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1813 register_color (pixel);
1814 #endif
1815 return color.pixel;
1816 }
1817
1818
1819 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1820 boosted.
1821
1822 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1823 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1824 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1825 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1826 use an additional additive factor.
1827
1828 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1829 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1830 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1831
1832
1833 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1834 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1835 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1836 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1837 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1838 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1839
1840 static int
1841 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1842 {
1843 XColor color, new;
1844 long bright;
1845 int success_p;
1846
1847 /* Get RGB color values. */
1848 color.pixel = *pixel;
1849 x_query_color (f, &color);
1850
1851 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1852 xassert (factor >= 0);
1853 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1854 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1855 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1856
1857 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1858 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1859
1860 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1861 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1862 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1863 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1864 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1865 {
1866 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1867 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1868 /* The additive adjustment. */
1869 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1870
1871 if (factor < 1)
1872 {
1873 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1874 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1875 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1876 }
1877 else
1878 {
1879 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1880 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1881 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1882 }
1883 }
1884
1885 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1886 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1887 if (success_p)
1888 {
1889 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1890 {
1891 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1892 delta to the RGB values. */
1893 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1894
1895 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1896 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1897 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1898 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1899 }
1900 else
1901 success_p = 1;
1902 *pixel = new.pixel;
1903 }
1904
1905 return success_p;
1906 }
1907
1908
1909 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1910 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1911 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1912 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1913 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1914 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1915
1916 static void
1917 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1918 {
1919 XGCValues xgcv;
1920 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1921 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1922 unsigned long pixel;
1923 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1924 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1925 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1926 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1927
1928 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1929 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1930
1931 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1932 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1933 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1934 if (relief->gc
1935 && relief->allocated_p)
1936 {
1937 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1938 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1939 }
1940
1941 /* Allocate new color. */
1942 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1943 pixel = background;
1944 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1945 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1946 {
1947 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1948 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1949 }
1950
1951 if (relief->gc == 0)
1952 {
1953 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1954 mask |= GCStipple;
1955 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1956 }
1957 else
1958 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1959 }
1960
1961
1962 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1963
1964 static void
1965 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1966 {
1967 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1968 unsigned long color;
1969
1970 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1971 color = s->face->box_color;
1972 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1973 && s->img->pixmap
1974 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1975 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1976 else
1977 {
1978 XGCValues xgcv;
1979
1980 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1981 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1982 color = xgcv.background;
1983 }
1984
1985 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1986 || color != di->relief_background)
1987 {
1988 di->relief_background = color;
1989 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1990 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1991 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1992 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1993 }
1994 }
1995
1996
1997 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1998 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1999 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2000 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2001 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2002 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2003 when drawing. */
2004
2005 static void
2006 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2007 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2008 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
2009 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2010 {
2011 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2012 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2013 int i;
2014 GC gc;
2015
2016 if (raised_p)
2017 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2018 else
2019 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2020 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2021
2022 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2023 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2024 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2025 corner pixels. */
2026
2027 /* Top. */
2028 if (top_p)
2029 {
2030 if (width == 1)
2031 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2032 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2033 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2034
2035 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2036 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2037 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2038 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2039 }
2040
2041 /* Left. */
2042 if (left_p)
2043 {
2044 if (width == 1)
2045 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2046
2047 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2048 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2049
2050 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2051 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2052 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2053 }
2054
2055 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2056 if (raised_p)
2057 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2058 else
2059 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2060 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2061
2062 if (width > 1)
2063 {
2064 /* Outermost top line. */
2065 if (top_p)
2066 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2067 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2068 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2069
2070 /* Outermost left line. */
2071 if (left_p)
2072 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2073 }
2074
2075 /* Bottom. */
2076 if (bot_p)
2077 {
2078 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2079 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2080 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2081 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2082 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2083 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2084 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2085 }
2086
2087 /* Right. */
2088 if (right_p)
2089 {
2090 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2091 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2092 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2093 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2094 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2095 }
2096
2097 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2098 }
2099
2100
2101 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2102 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2103 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2104 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2105 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2106 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2107
2108 static void
2109 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2110 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2111 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2112 {
2113 XGCValues xgcv;
2114
2115 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2116 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2117 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2118
2119 /* Top. */
2120 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2121 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2122
2123 /* Left. */
2124 if (left_p)
2125 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2126 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2127
2128 /* Bottom. */
2129 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2130 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2131
2132 /* Right. */
2133 if (right_p)
2134 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2135 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2136
2137 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2138 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2139 }
2140
2141
2142 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2143
2144 static void
2145 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2146 {
2147 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2148 int left_p, right_p;
2149 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2150 XRectangle clip_rect;
2151
2152 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2153 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2154 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2155
2156 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2157 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2158 ? s->first_glyph
2159 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2160
2161 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2162 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2163 left_x = s->x;
2164 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2165 ? last_x - 1
2166 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2167 top_y = s->y;
2168 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2169
2170 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2171 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2172 && (s->prev == NULL
2173 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2174 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2175 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2176 && (s->next == NULL
2177 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2178
2179 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2180
2181 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2182 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2183 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2184 else
2185 {
2186 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2187 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2188 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2189 }
2190 }
2191
2192
2193 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2194
2195 static void
2196 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2197 {
2198 int x = s->x;
2199 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2200
2201 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2202 right of that line. */
2203 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2204 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2205 && s->slice.x == 0)
2206 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2207
2208 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2209 by that margin. */
2210 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2211 x += s->img->hmargin;
2212 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2213 y += s->img->vmargin;
2214
2215 if (s->img->pixmap)
2216 {
2217 if (s->img->mask)
2218 {
2219 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2220 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2221 trust on the shape extension to be available
2222 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2223 manually. */
2224 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2225 | GCFunction);
2226 XGCValues xgcv;
2227 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2228
2229 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2230 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2231 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2232 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2233 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2234
2235 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2236 image_rect.x = x;
2237 image_rect.y = y;
2238 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2239 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2240 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2241 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2242 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2243 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2244 }
2245 else
2246 {
2247 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2248
2249 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2250 image_rect.x = x;
2251 image_rect.y = y;
2252 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2253 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2254 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2255 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2256 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2257 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2258
2259 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2260 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2261 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2262 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2263 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2264 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2265 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2266 {
2267 int r = s->img->relief;
2268 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2269 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2270 x - r, y - r,
2271 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2272 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2273 }
2274 }
2275 }
2276 else
2277 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2278 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2279 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2280 }
2281
2282
2283 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2284
2285 static void
2286 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2287 {
2288 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2289 XRectangle r;
2290 int x = s->x;
2291 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2292
2293 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2294 right of that line. */
2295 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2296 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2297 && s->slice.x == 0)
2298 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2299
2300 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2301 by that margin. */
2302 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2303 x += s->img->hmargin;
2304 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2305 y += s->img->vmargin;
2306
2307 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2308 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2309 {
2310 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2311 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2312 }
2313 else
2314 {
2315 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2316 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2317 }
2318
2319 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2320 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2321
2322 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2323 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2324 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2325 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2326
2327 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2328 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2329 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2330 s->slice.y == 0,
2331 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2332 s->slice.x == 0,
2333 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2334 &r);
2335 }
2336
2337
2338 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2339
2340 static void
2341 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2342 {
2343 int x = 0;
2344 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2345
2346 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2347 right of that line. */
2348 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2349 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2350 && s->slice.x == 0)
2351 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2352
2353 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2354 by that margin. */
2355 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2356 x += s->img->hmargin;
2357 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2358 y += s->img->vmargin;
2359
2360 if (s->img->pixmap)
2361 {
2362 if (s->img->mask)
2363 {
2364 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2365 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2366 trust on the shape extension to be available
2367 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2368 manually. */
2369 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2370 | GCFunction);
2371 XGCValues xgcv;
2372
2373 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2374 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2375 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2376 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2377 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2378
2379 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2380 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2381 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2382 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2383 }
2384 else
2385 {
2386 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2387 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2388 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2389
2390 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2391 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2392 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2393 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2394 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2395 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2396 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2397 {
2398 int r = s->img->relief;
2399 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2400 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2401 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2402 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2403 }
2404 }
2405 }
2406 else
2407 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2408 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2409 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2410 }
2411
2412
2413 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2414 give the rectangle to draw. */
2415
2416 static void
2417 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2418 {
2419 if (s->stippled_p)
2420 {
2421 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2422 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2423 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2424 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2425 }
2426 else
2427 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2428 }
2429
2430
2431 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2432
2433 s->y
2434 s->x +-------------------------
2435 | s->face->box
2436 |
2437 | +-------------------------
2438 | | s->img->margin
2439 | |
2440 | | +-------------------
2441 | | | the image
2442
2443 */
2444
2445 static void
2446 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2447 {
2448 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2449 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2450 int height;
2451 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2452
2453 height = s->height;
2454 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2455 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2456 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2457 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2458
2459 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2460 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2461 flickering. */
2462 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2463 if (height > s->slice.height
2464 || s->img->hmargin
2465 || s->img->vmargin
2466 || s->img->mask
2467 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2468 || s->width != s->background_width)
2469 {
2470 if (s->img->mask)
2471 {
2472 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2473 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2474 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2475 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2476 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2477
2478 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2479 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2480 s->background_width,
2481 s->height, depth);
2482
2483 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2484 pixmap. */
2485 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2486
2487 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2488 if (s->stippled_p)
2489 {
2490 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2491 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2492 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2493 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2494 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2495 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2496 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2497 }
2498 else
2499 {
2500 XGCValues xgcv;
2501 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2502 &xgcv);
2503 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2504 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2505 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2506 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2507 }
2508 }
2509 else
2510 {
2511 int x = s->x;
2512 int y = s->y;
2513
2514 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2515 && s->slice.x == 0)
2516 x += box_line_hwidth;
2517
2518 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2519 y += box_line_vwidth;
2520
2521 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2522 }
2523
2524 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2525 }
2526
2527 /* Draw the foreground. */
2528 if (pixmap != None)
2529 {
2530 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2531 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2532 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2533 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2534 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2535 }
2536 else
2537 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2538
2539 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2540 if (s->img->relief
2541 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2542 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2543 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2544 }
2545
2546
2547 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2548
2549 static void
2550 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2551 {
2552 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2553
2554 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2555 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2556 {
2557 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2558 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2559 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2560 int x = s->x;
2561
2562 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2563 {
2564 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2565
2566 if (x < left_x)
2567 {
2568 background_width -= left_x - x;
2569 x = left_x;
2570 }
2571 }
2572 else
2573 {
2574 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2575 stretch glyph. */
2576 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2577
2578 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2579 background_width -= x - right_x;
2580 x += background_width;
2581 }
2582 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2583 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2584 x -= width;
2585
2586 /* Draw cursor. */
2587 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2588
2589 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2590 if (width < background_width)
2591 {
2592 int y = s->y;
2593 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2594 XRectangle r;
2595 GC gc;
2596
2597 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2598 x += width;
2599 else
2600 x = s->x;
2601 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2602 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2603 {
2604 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2605 gc = s->gc;
2606 }
2607 else
2608 gc = s->face->gc;
2609
2610 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2611 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2612
2613 if (s->face->stipple)
2614 {
2615 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2616 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2617 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2618 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2619 }
2620 else
2621 {
2622 XGCValues xgcv;
2623 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2624 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2625 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2626 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2627 }
2628 }
2629 }
2630 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2631 {
2632 int background_width = s->background_width;
2633 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2634
2635 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2636 except for header line and mode line. */
2637 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2638 {
2639 background_width -= left_x - x;
2640 x = left_x;
2641 }
2642 if (background_width > 0)
2643 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2644 }
2645
2646 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2647 }
2648
2649
2650 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2651
2652 static void
2653 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2654 {
2655 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2656
2657 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2658 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2659 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2660 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2661 {
2662 int width;
2663 struct glyph_string *next;
2664
2665 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2666 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2667 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2668 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2669 {
2670 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2671 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2672 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2673 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2674 else
2675 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2676 next->num_clips = 0;
2677 }
2678 }
2679
2680 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2681 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2682
2683 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2684 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2685 if (!s->for_overlaps
2686 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2687 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2688 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2689
2690 {
2691 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2692 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2693 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2694 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2695 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2696 }
2697 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2698 && !s->clip_tail
2699 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2700 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2701 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2702 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2703 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2704 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2705 else
2706 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2707
2708 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2709 {
2710 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2711 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2712 break;
2713
2714 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2715 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2716 break;
2717
2718 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2719 if (s->for_overlaps)
2720 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2721 else
2722 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2723 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2724 break;
2725
2726 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2727 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2728 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2729 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2730 else
2731 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2732 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2733 break;
2734
2735 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2736 if (s->for_overlaps)
2737 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2738 else
2739 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2740 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2741 break;
2742
2743 default:
2744 abort ();
2745 }
2746
2747 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2748 {
2749 /* Draw underline. */
2750 if (s->face->underline_p)
2751 {
2752 unsigned long thickness, position;
2753 int y;
2754
2755 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2756 {
2757 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2758 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2759 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2760 }
2761 else
2762 {
2763 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2764 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2765 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2766 else
2767 thickness = 1;
2768 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2769 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2770 else
2771 {
2772 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2773 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2774 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2775 specs, and its default is
2776
2777 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2778 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2779
2780 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2781 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2782 position = s->font->underline_position;
2783 else if (s->font)
2784 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2785 else
2786 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2787 }
2788 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2789 }
2790 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2791 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2792 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2793 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2794 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2795 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2796 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2797 s->underline_position = position;
2798 y = s->ybase + position;
2799 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2800 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2801 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2802 else
2803 {
2804 XGCValues xgcv;
2805 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2806 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2807 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2808 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2809 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2810 }
2811 }
2812
2813 /* Draw overline. */
2814 if (s->face->overline_p)
2815 {
2816 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2817
2818 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2819 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2820 s->width, h);
2821 else
2822 {
2823 XGCValues xgcv;
2824 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2825 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2826 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2827 s->width, h);
2828 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2829 }
2830 }
2831
2832 /* Draw strike-through. */
2833 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2834 {
2835 unsigned long h = 1;
2836 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2837
2838 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2839 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2840 s->width, h);
2841 else
2842 {
2843 XGCValues xgcv;
2844 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2845 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2846 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2847 s->width, h);
2848 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2849 }
2850 }
2851
2852 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2853 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2854 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2855
2856 if (s->prev)
2857 {
2858 struct glyph_string *prev;
2859
2860 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2861 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2862 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2863 {
2864 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2865 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2866 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2867
2868 prev->hl = s->hl;
2869 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2870 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2871 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2872 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2873 else
2874 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2875 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2876 prev->hl = save;
2877 prev->num_clips = 0;
2878 }
2879 }
2880
2881 if (s->next)
2882 {
2883 struct glyph_string *next;
2884
2885 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2886 if (next->hl != s->hl
2887 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2888 {
2889 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2890 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2891 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2892
2893 next->hl = s->hl;
2894 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2895 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2896 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2897 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2898 else
2899 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2900 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2901 next->hl = save;
2902 next->num_clips = 0;
2903 }
2904 }
2905 }
2906
2907 /* Reset clipping. */
2908 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2909 s->num_clips = 0;
2910 }
2911
2912 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2913
2914 void
2915 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2916 {
2917 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2918 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2919 x, y, width, height,
2920 x + shift_by, y);
2921 }
2922
2923 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2924 for X frames. */
2925
2926 static void
2927 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2928 {
2929 abort ();
2930 }
2931
2932
2933 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2934 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2935
2936 void
2937 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2938 {
2939 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2940 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2941 }
2942
2943
2944 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2945
2946 static void
2947 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2948 {
2949 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2950 longer visible. */
2951 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2952 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2953 output_cursor.x = -1;
2954
2955 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2956 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2957 BLOCK_INPUT;
2958 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2959
2960 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2961 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2962 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2963
2964 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2965 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2966 redisplay, do it here. */
2967 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2968 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2969 #endif
2970
2971 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2972
2973 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2974 }
2975
2976
2977 \f
2978 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2979
2980 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2981 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2982
2983 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2984
2985
2986 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2987 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2988
2989 static int
2990 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
2991 {
2992 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2993 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2994 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2995 {
2996 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2997 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2998 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2999 }
3000
3001 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
3002 {
3003 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
3004 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
3005 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
3006 }
3007
3008 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
3009 positive. */
3010 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
3011 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
3012
3013 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
3014 negative. */
3015 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
3016 }
3017
3018 void
3019 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3020 {
3021 BLOCK_INPUT;
3022
3023 {
3024 #ifdef USE_GTK
3025 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3026 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3027 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3028 GdkGCValues vals;
3029 GdkGC *gc;
3030 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3031 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3032 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3033 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3034 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3035 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3036 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3037 #else
3038 GC gc;
3039
3040 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3041 pixels into background pixels. */
3042 {
3043 XGCValues values;
3044
3045 values.function = GXxor;
3046 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3047 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3048
3049 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3050 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3051 }
3052 #endif
3053 {
3054 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3055 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3056 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3057 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3058 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3059 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3060 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3061
3062 int width;
3063
3064 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3065 edge it is next to. */
3066 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3067 {
3068 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3069 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3070 break;
3071
3072 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3073 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3074 break;
3075
3076 default:
3077 break;
3078 }
3079
3080 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3081
3082 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3083 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3084 {
3085 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3086 flash_left,
3087 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3088 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3089 width, flash_height);
3090 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3091 flash_left,
3092 (height - flash_height
3093 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3094 width, flash_height);
3095
3096 }
3097 else
3098 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3099 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3100 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3101 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3102
3103 x_flush (f);
3104
3105 {
3106 struct timeval wakeup;
3107
3108 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3109
3110 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3111 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3112 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3113 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3114
3115 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3116 available. */
3117 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3118 {
3119 struct timeval current;
3120 struct timeval timeout;
3121
3122 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3123
3124 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3125 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3126 break;
3127
3128 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3129 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3130 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3131
3132 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3133 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3134 }
3135 }
3136
3137 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3138 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3139 {
3140 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3141 flash_left,
3142 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3143 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3144 width, flash_height);
3145 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3146 flash_left,
3147 (height - flash_height
3148 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3149 width, flash_height);
3150 }
3151 else
3152 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3153 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3154 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3155 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3156
3157 #ifdef USE_GTK
3158 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3159 #undef XFillRectangle
3160 #else
3161 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3162 #endif
3163 x_flush (f);
3164 }
3165 }
3166
3167 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3168 }
3169
3170 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3171
3172
3173 static void
3174 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3175 {
3176 BLOCK_INPUT;
3177 if (invisible)
3178 {
3179 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3180 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3181 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3182 }
3183 else
3184 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3185 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3186 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3187 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3188 }
3189
3190
3191 /* Make audible bell. */
3192
3193 void
3194 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3195 {
3196 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3197 {
3198 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3199 if (visible_bell)
3200 XTflash (f);
3201 else
3202 #endif
3203 {
3204 BLOCK_INPUT;
3205 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3206 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3207 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3208 }
3209 }
3210 }
3211
3212 \f
3213 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3214 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3215 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3216 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3217
3218 static void
3219 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3220 {
3221 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3222 }
3223
3224
3225 \f
3226 /***********************************************************************
3227 Line Dance
3228 ***********************************************************************/
3229
3230 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3231 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3232
3233 static void
3234 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3235 {
3236 abort ();
3237 }
3238
3239
3240 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3241
3242 static void
3243 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3244 {
3245 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3246 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3247
3248 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3249 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3250 fringe of W. */
3251 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3252
3253 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3254 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3255 bottom_y = y + height;
3256
3257 if (to_y < from_y)
3258 {
3259 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3260 line at the bottom. */
3261 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3262 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3263 else
3264 height = run->height;
3265 }
3266 else
3267 {
3268 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3269 at the bottom. */
3270 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3271 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3272 else
3273 height = run->height;
3274 }
3275
3276 BLOCK_INPUT;
3277
3278 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3279 updated_window = w;
3280 x_clear_cursor (w);
3281
3282 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3283 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3284 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3285 x, from_y,
3286 width, height,
3287 x, to_y);
3288
3289 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3290 }
3291
3292
3293 \f
3294 /***********************************************************************
3295 Exposure Events
3296 ***********************************************************************/
3297
3298 \f
3299 static void
3300 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3301 {
3302 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3303 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3304 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3305 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3306 BLOCK_INPUT;
3307 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3308 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3309 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3310 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3311 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3312 }
3313
3314 static void
3315 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3316 {
3317 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3318 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3319 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3320 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3321 BLOCK_INPUT;
3322 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3323 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3324 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3325 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3326 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3327 }
3328
3329 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3330 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3331 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3332 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3333 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3334
3335 static void
3336 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3337 {
3338 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3339
3340 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3341 {
3342 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3343 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3344 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3345
3346 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3347 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3348
3349 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3350 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3351 else
3352 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3353 }
3354
3355 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3356 }
3357
3358 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3359 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3360 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3361
3362 static void
3363 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3364 {
3365 if (type == FocusIn)
3366 {
3367 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3368 {
3369 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3370 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3371
3372 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3373 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3374 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3375 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3376 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3377 {
3378 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3379 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3380 }
3381 }
3382
3383 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3384
3385 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3386 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3387 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3388 #endif
3389 }
3390 else if (type == FocusOut)
3391 {
3392 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3393
3394 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3395 {
3396 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3397 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3398 }
3399
3400 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3401 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3402 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3403 #endif
3404 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3405 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3406 }
3407 }
3408
3409 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3410 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3411
3412 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3413
3414 static void
3415 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3416 {
3417 struct frame *frame;
3418
3419 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3420 if (! frame)
3421 return;
3422
3423 switch (event->type)
3424 {
3425 case EnterNotify:
3426 case LeaveNotify:
3427 {
3428 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3429 int focus_state
3430 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3431
3432 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3433 && event->xcrossing.focus
3434 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3435 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3436 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3437 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3438 }
3439 break;
3440
3441 case FocusIn:
3442 case FocusOut:
3443 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3444 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3445 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3446 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3447 break;
3448
3449 case ClientMessage:
3450 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3451 {
3452 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3453 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3454 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3455 }
3456 break;
3457 }
3458 }
3459
3460
3461 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3462
3463 void
3464 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3465 {
3466 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3467 }
3468
3469 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3470 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3471 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3472
3473 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3474 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3475 the appropriate X display info. */
3476
3477 static void
3478 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3479 {
3480 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3481 }
3482
3483 static void
3484 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3485 {
3486 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3487
3488 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3489 {
3490 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3491 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3492 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3493 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3494 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3495 {
3496 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3497 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3498 }
3499 }
3500 else
3501 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3502
3503 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3504 {
3505 if (old_highlight)
3506 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3507 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3508 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3509 }
3510 }
3511
3512
3513 \f
3514 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3515
3516 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3517 static void
3518 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3519 {
3520 int min_code, max_code;
3521 KeySym *syms;
3522 int syms_per_code;
3523 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3524
3525 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3526 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3527 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3528 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3529 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3530
3531 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3532
3533 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3534 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3535 &syms_per_code);
3536 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3537
3538 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3539 Alt keysyms are on. */
3540 {
3541 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3542 int found_alt_or_meta;
3543
3544 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3545 {
3546 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3547 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3548 {
3549 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3550
3551 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3552 if (code == 0)
3553 continue;
3554
3555 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3556 {
3557 int code_col;
3558
3559 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3560 {
3561 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3562
3563 switch (sym)
3564 {
3565 case XK_Meta_L:
3566 case XK_Meta_R:
3567 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3568 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3569 break;
3570
3571 case XK_Alt_L:
3572 case XK_Alt_R:
3573 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3574 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3575 break;
3576
3577 case XK_Hyper_L:
3578 case XK_Hyper_R:
3579 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3580 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3581 code_col = syms_per_code;
3582 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3583 break;
3584
3585 case XK_Super_L:
3586 case XK_Super_R:
3587 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3588 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3589 code_col = syms_per_code;
3590 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3591 break;
3592
3593 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3594 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3595 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3596 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3597 code_col = syms_per_code;
3598 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3599 break;
3600 }
3601 }
3602 }
3603 }
3604 }
3605 }
3606
3607 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3608 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3609 {
3610 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3611 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3612 }
3613
3614 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3615 make them just meta, not alt. */
3616 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3617 {
3618 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3619 }
3620
3621 XFree ((char *) syms);
3622 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3623 }
3624
3625 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3626 Emacs uses. */
3627
3628 unsigned int
3629 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3630 {
3631 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3632 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3633 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3634 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3635 Lisp_Object tem;
3636
3637 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3638 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3639 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3640 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3641 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3642 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3643 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3644 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3645
3646
3647 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3648 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3649 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3650 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3651 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3652 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3653 }
3654
3655 static unsigned int
3656 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3657 {
3658 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3659 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3660 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3661 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3662
3663 Lisp_Object tem;
3664
3665 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3666 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3667 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3668 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3669 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3670 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3671 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3672 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3673
3674
3675 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3676 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3677 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3678 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3679 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3680 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3681 }
3682
3683 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3684
3685 char *
3686 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3687 {
3688 char *value;
3689
3690 BLOCK_INPUT;
3691 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3692 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3693
3694 return value;
3695 }
3696
3697
3698 \f
3699 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3700
3701 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3702
3703 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3704 the mouse. */
3705
3706 static Lisp_Object
3707 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3708 {
3709 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3710 otherwise. */
3711 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3712 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3713 result->timestamp = event->time;
3714 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3715 event->state)
3716 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3717 ? up_modifier
3718 : down_modifier));
3719
3720 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3721 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3722 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3723 result->arg = Qnil;
3724 return Qnil;
3725 }
3726
3727 \f
3728 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3729 The input handler calls this.
3730
3731 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3732 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3733 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3734 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3735
3736 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3737 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3738
3739 static int
3740 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3741 {
3742 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3743 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3744 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3745
3746 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3747 return 0;
3748
3749 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3750 {
3751 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3752 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3753 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3754 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3755 return 1;
3756 }
3757
3758
3759 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3760 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3761 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3762 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3763 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3764 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3765 {
3766 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3767 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3768 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3769 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3770 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3771 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3772 return 1;
3773 }
3774
3775 return 0;
3776 }
3777
3778 \f
3779 /************************************************************************
3780 Mouse Face
3781 ************************************************************************/
3782
3783 static void
3784 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3785 {
3786 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3787 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3788 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3789 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3790 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3791 }
3792
3793
3794
3795 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3796 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3797
3798 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3799 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3800 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3801 position on the scroll bar.
3802
3803 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3804 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3805 the mouse is over.
3806
3807 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3808 was at this position.
3809
3810 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3811
3812 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3813 movement. */
3814
3815 static void
3816 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
3817 {
3818 FRAME_PTR f1;
3819
3820 BLOCK_INPUT;
3821
3822 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3823 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3824 else
3825 {
3826 Window root;
3827 int root_x, root_y;
3828
3829 Window dummy_window;
3830 int dummy;
3831
3832 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3833
3834 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3835 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3836 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3837 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3838 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3839
3840 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3841
3842 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3843 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3844 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3845
3846 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3847 &root,
3848
3849 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3850 a different screen. */
3851 &dummy_window,
3852
3853 /* The position on that root window. */
3854 &root_x, &root_y,
3855
3856 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3857 &dummy, &dummy,
3858
3859 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3860 we don't care. */
3861 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3862
3863 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3864 containing the pointer. */
3865 {
3866 Window win, child;
3867 int win_x, win_y;
3868 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3869
3870 win = root;
3871
3872 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3873 structure is changing at the same time this function
3874 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3875
3876 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3877
3878 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3879 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3880 {
3881 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3882 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3883 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3884
3885 /* From-window, to-window. */
3886 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3887
3888 /* From-position, to-position. */
3889 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3890
3891 /* Child of win. */
3892 &child);
3893 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3894 }
3895 else
3896 {
3897 while (1)
3898 {
3899 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3900
3901 /* From-window, to-window. */
3902 root, win,
3903
3904 /* From-position, to-position. */
3905 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3906
3907 /* Child of win. */
3908 &child);
3909
3910 if (child == None || child == win)
3911 break;
3912 #ifdef USE_GTK
3913 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3914 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3915 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3916 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3917 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3918 break;
3919 #endif
3920 win = child;
3921 parent_x = win_x;
3922 parent_y = win_y;
3923 }
3924
3925 /* Now we know that:
3926 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3927 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3928 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3929 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3930 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3931 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3932 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3933 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3934 never use them in that case.) */
3935
3936 #ifdef USE_GTK
3937 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3938 want the edit window. */
3939 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3940 #else
3941 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3942 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3943 #endif
3944
3945 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3946 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3947 on the frame. */
3948 if (f1 != NULL
3949 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3950 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3951 f1 = NULL;
3952 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3953 }
3954
3955 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3956 f1 = 0;
3957
3958 x_uncatch_errors ();
3959
3960 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3961 if (! f1)
3962 {
3963 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3964
3965 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3966
3967 if (bar)
3968 {
3969 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3970 win_x = parent_x;
3971 win_y = parent_y;
3972 }
3973 }
3974
3975 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3976 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3977
3978 if (f1)
3979 {
3980 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3981 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3982 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3983 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3984 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3985 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3986 the frame are divided into. */
3987
3988 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3989 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3990
3991 *bar_window = Qnil;
3992 *part = 0;
3993 *fp = f1;
3994 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3995 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3996 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3997 }
3998 }
3999 }
4000
4001 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4002 }
4003
4004
4005 \f
4006 /***********************************************************************
4007 Scroll bars
4008 ***********************************************************************/
4009
4010 /* Scroll bar support. */
4011
4012 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4013 manages it.
4014 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4015 bits. */
4016
4017 static struct scroll_bar *
4018 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4019 {
4020 Lisp_Object tail;
4021
4022 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4023 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4024 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4025
4026 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4027 {
4028 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4029
4030 frame = XCAR (tail);
4031 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4032 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4033 abort ();
4034
4035 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4036 continue;
4037
4038 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4039 right window ID. */
4040 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4041 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4042 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4043 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4044 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4045 condemned = Qnil,
4046 ! NILP (bar));
4047 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4048 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4049 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4050 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4051 }
4052
4053 return 0;
4054 }
4055
4056
4057 #if defined USE_LUCID
4058
4059 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4060 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4061
4062 static Widget
4063 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4064 {
4065 Lisp_Object tail;
4066
4067 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4068 {
4069 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4070 {
4071 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4072 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4073
4074 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4075 return menu_bar;
4076 }
4077 }
4078
4079 return NULL;
4080 }
4081
4082 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4083
4084 \f
4085 /************************************************************************
4086 Toolkit scroll bars
4087 ************************************************************************/
4088
4089 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4090
4091 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4092 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4093 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4094 struct scroll_bar *);
4095 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4096 int, int, int);
4097
4098
4099 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4100 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4101
4102 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4103
4104 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4105
4106 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4107
4108 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4109 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4110
4111 #ifndef USE_GTK
4112 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4113
4114 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4115
4116 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4117
4118 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4119 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4120 to avoid jerkyness. */
4121
4122 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4123
4124 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4125 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4126 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4127 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4128
4129 static void
4130 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4131 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4132 {
4133 int scroll_bar_p;
4134 const char *end_action;
4135
4136 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4137 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4138 end_action = "Release";
4139 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4140 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4141 end_action = "EndScroll";
4142 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4143
4144 if (scroll_bar_p
4145 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4146 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4147 {
4148 struct window *w;
4149
4150 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4151 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4152 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4153
4154 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4155 {
4156 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4157 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4158 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4159 }
4160 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4161 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4162
4163 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4164 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4165 }
4166 }
4167 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4168
4169 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4170 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4171
4172 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4173 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4174
4175
4176 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4177 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4178 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4179 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4180
4181 static void
4182 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4183 {
4184 XEvent event;
4185 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4186 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4187 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4188 int i;
4189
4190 BLOCK_INPUT;
4191
4192 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4193 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4194 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4195 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4196 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4197 ev->format = 32;
4198
4199 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4200 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4201 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4202 into that array in the event. */
4203 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4204 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4205 break;
4206
4207 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4208 {
4209 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4210 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4211 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4212
4213 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4214 nbytes);
4215 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4216 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4217 }
4218
4219 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4220 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4221 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4222 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4223 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4224 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4225
4226 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4227 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4228 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4229 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4230 #endif
4231
4232 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4233 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4234 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4235 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4236 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4237 }
4238
4239
4240 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4241 in *IEVENT. */
4242
4243 static void
4244 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4245 {
4246 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4247 Lisp_Object window;
4248 struct frame *f;
4249 struct window *w;
4250
4251 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4252 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4253
4254 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4255 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4256
4257 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4258 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4259 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4260 #ifdef USE_GTK
4261 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4262 #else
4263 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4264 #endif
4265 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4266 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4267 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4268 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4269 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4270 }
4271
4272
4273 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4274
4275 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4276
4277 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4278
4279
4280 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4281 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4282 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4283
4284 static void
4285 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4286 {
4287 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4288 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4289 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4290
4291 switch (cs->reason)
4292 {
4293 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4294 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4295 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4296 break;
4297
4298 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4299 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4300 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4301 break;
4302
4303 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4304 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4305 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4306 break;
4307
4308 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4309 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4310 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4311 break;
4312
4313 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4314 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4315 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4316 break;
4317
4318 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4319 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4320 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4321 break;
4322
4323 case XmCR_DRAG:
4324 {
4325 int slider_size;
4326
4327 /* Get the slider size. */
4328 BLOCK_INPUT;
4329 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4330 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4331
4332 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4333 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4334 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4335 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4336 }
4337 break;
4338
4339 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4340 break;
4341 };
4342
4343 if (part >= 0)
4344 {
4345 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4346 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4347 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4348 }
4349 }
4350
4351 #elif defined USE_GTK
4352
4353 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4354 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4355
4356 static gboolean
4357 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4358 GtkScrollType scroll,
4359 gdouble value,
4360 gpointer user_data)
4361 {
4362 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4363 gdouble position;
4364 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4365 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4366 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4367
4368 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4369 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4370
4371
4372 switch (scroll)
4373 {
4374 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4375 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4376 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4377 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4378 {
4379 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4380 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4381 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4382 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4383 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4384 }
4385 break;
4386 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4387 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4388 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4389 break;
4390 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4391 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4392 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4393 break;
4394 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4395 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4396 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4397 break;
4398 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4399 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4400 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4401 break;
4402 }
4403
4404 if (part >= 0)
4405 {
4406 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4407 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4408 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4409 }
4410
4411 return FALSE;
4412 }
4413
4414 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4415
4416 static gboolean
4417 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4418 GdkEventButton *event,
4419 gpointer user_data)
4420 {
4421 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4422 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4423 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4424 {
4425 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4426 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4427 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4428 }
4429
4430 return FALSE;
4431 }
4432
4433
4434 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4435
4436 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4437 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4438 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4439 the thumb is. */
4440
4441 static void
4442 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4443 {
4444 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4445 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4446 float shown;
4447 int whole, portion, height;
4448 int part;
4449
4450 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4451 BLOCK_INPUT;
4452 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4453 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4454
4455 whole = 10000000;
4456 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4457
4458 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4459 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4460 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4461 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4462 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4463 bottom). */
4464 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4465 else
4466 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4467
4468 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4469 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4470 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4471 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4472 }
4473
4474
4475 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4476 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4477 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4478 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4479 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4480 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4481 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4482
4483 static void
4484 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4485 {
4486 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4487 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4488 int position = (long) call_data;
4489 Dimension height;
4490 int part;
4491
4492 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4493 BLOCK_INPUT;
4494 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4495 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4496
4497 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4498 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4499
4500 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4501 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4502 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4503 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4504 else
4505 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4506
4507 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4508 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4509 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4510 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4511 }
4512
4513 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4514
4515 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4516
4517 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4518 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4519
4520 #ifdef USE_GTK
4521 static void
4522 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4523 {
4524 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4525
4526 BLOCK_INPUT;
4527 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4528 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4529 scroll_bar_name);
4530 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4531 }
4532
4533 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4534
4535 static void
4536 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4537 {
4538 Window xwindow;
4539 Widget widget;
4540 Arg av[20];
4541 int ac = 0;
4542 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4543 unsigned long pixel;
4544
4545 BLOCK_INPUT;
4546
4547 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4548 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4549 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4550 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4551 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4552 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4553 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4554 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4555 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4556
4557 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4558 if (pixel != -1)
4559 {
4560 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4561 ++ac;
4562 }
4563
4564 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4565 if (pixel != -1)
4566 {
4567 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4568 ++ac;
4569 }
4570
4571 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4572 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4573
4574 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4575 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4576 (XtPointer) bar);
4577 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4578 (XtPointer) bar);
4579 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4580 (XtPointer) bar);
4581 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4582 (XtPointer) bar);
4583 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4584 (XtPointer) bar);
4585 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4586 (XtPointer) bar);
4587 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4588 (XtPointer) bar);
4589
4590 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4591 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4592
4593 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4594 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4595 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4596 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4597
4598 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4599
4600 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4601 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4602 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4603 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4604 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4605 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4606 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4607 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4608
4609 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4610 if (pixel != -1)
4611 {
4612 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4613 ++ac;
4614 }
4615
4616 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4617 if (pixel != -1)
4618 {
4619 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4620 ++ac;
4621 }
4622
4623 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4624
4625 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4626 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4627 {
4628 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4629 if (pixel != -1)
4630 {
4631 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4632 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4633 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4634 pixel = -1;
4635 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4636 }
4637 }
4638 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4639 {
4640 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4641 if (pixel != -1)
4642 {
4643 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4644 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4645 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4646 pixel = -1;
4647 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4648 }
4649 }
4650
4651 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4652 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4653 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4654 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4655 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4656 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4657 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4658 colors itself. */
4659 {
4660 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4661 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4662 ++ac;
4663 }
4664 else
4665 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4666 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4667 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4668 {
4669 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4670 the shadows. */
4671 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4672 ++ac;
4673
4674 /* Specify the colors. */
4675 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4676 if (pixel != -1)
4677 {
4678 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4679 ++ac;
4680 }
4681 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4682 if (pixel != -1)
4683 {
4684 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4685 ++ac;
4686 }
4687 }
4688 #endif
4689
4690 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4691 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4692
4693 {
4694 char *initial = "";
4695 char *val = initial;
4696 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4697 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4698 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4699 #endif
4700 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4701 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4702 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4703 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4704 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4705 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4706 }
4707 }
4708
4709 /* Define callbacks. */
4710 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4711 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4712 (XtPointer) bar);
4713
4714 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4715 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4716
4717 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4718
4719 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4720 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4721 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4722 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4723
4724 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4725 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4726 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4727 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4728
4729 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4730 }
4731 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4732
4733
4734 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4735 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4736
4737 #ifdef USE_GTK
4738 static void
4739 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4740 {
4741 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4742 }
4743
4744 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4745 static void
4746 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4747 int whole)
4748 {
4749 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4750 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4751 float top, shown;
4752
4753 BLOCK_INPUT;
4754
4755 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4756
4757 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4758 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4759 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4760 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4761 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4762 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4763 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4764 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4765 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4766 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4767 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4768 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4769 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4770 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4771 whole += portion;
4772
4773 if (whole <= 0)
4774 top = 0, shown = 1;
4775 else
4776 {
4777 top = (float) position / whole;
4778 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4779 }
4780
4781 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4782 {
4783 int size, value;
4784
4785 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4786 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4787 value. */
4788 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4789 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4790 size = max (size, 1);
4791
4792 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4793 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4794 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4795
4796 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4797 }
4798 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4799
4800 if (whole == 0)
4801 top = 0, shown = 1;
4802 else
4803 {
4804 top = (float) position / whole;
4805 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4806 }
4807
4808 {
4809 float old_top, old_shown;
4810 Dimension height;
4811 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4812 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4813 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4814 XtNheight, &height,
4815 NULL);
4816
4817 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4818 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4819 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4820 else
4821 top = old_top;
4822 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4823 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4824
4825 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4826 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4827 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4828 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4829 {
4830 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4831 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4832 else
4833 {
4834 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4835 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4836 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4837
4838 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4839 }
4840 }
4841 }
4842 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4843
4844 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4845 }
4846 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4847
4848 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4849
4850
4851 \f
4852 /************************************************************************
4853 Scroll bars, general
4854 ************************************************************************/
4855
4856 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4857 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4858 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4859 scroll bar. */
4860
4861 static struct scroll_bar *
4862 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4863 {
4864 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4865 struct scroll_bar *bar
4866 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4867
4868 BLOCK_INPUT;
4869
4870 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4871 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4872 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4873 {
4874 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4875 unsigned long mask;
4876 Window window;
4877
4878 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4879 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4880 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4881
4882 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4883 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4884 | ExposureMask);
4885 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4886
4887 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4888
4889 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4890 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4891 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4892 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4893 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4894 left, top, width,
4895 window_box_height (w), False);
4896
4897 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4898 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4899 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4900 top,
4901 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4902 height,
4903 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4904 0,
4905 CopyFromParent,
4906 CopyFromParent,
4907 CopyFromParent,
4908 /* Attributes. */
4909 mask, &a);
4910 bar->x_window = window;
4911 }
4912 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4913
4914 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4915 bar->top = top;
4916 bar->left = left;
4917 bar->width = width;
4918 bar->height = height;
4919 bar->start = 0;
4920 bar->end = 0;
4921 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4922 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4923
4924 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4925 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4926 bar->prev = Qnil;
4927 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4928 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4929 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4930
4931 /* Map the window/widget. */
4932 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4933 {
4934 #ifdef USE_GTK
4935 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4936 bar->x_window,
4937 top,
4938 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4939 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4940 max (height, 1));
4941 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4942 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4943 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4944 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4945 top,
4946 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4947 max (height, 1), 0);
4948 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4949 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4950 }
4951 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4952 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4953 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4954
4955 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4956 return bar;
4957 }
4958
4959
4960 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4961
4962 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4963
4964 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4965 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4966 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4967 events.)
4968
4969 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4970 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4971 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4972 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4973 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4974
4975 static void
4976 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
4977 {
4978 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4979 Window w = bar->x_window;
4980 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4981 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4982
4983 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4984 if (! rebuild
4985 && start == bar->start
4986 && end == bar->end)
4987 return;
4988
4989 BLOCK_INPUT;
4990
4991 {
4992 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
4993 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
4994 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
4995
4996 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4997 the distance between start and end. */
4998 {
4999 int length = end - start;
5000
5001 if (start < 0)
5002 start = 0;
5003 else if (start > top_range)
5004 start = top_range;
5005 end = start + length;
5006
5007 if (end < start)
5008 end = start;
5009 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5010 end = top_range;
5011 }
5012
5013 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5014 bar->start = start;
5015 bar->end = end;
5016
5017 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5018 if (end > top_range)
5019 end = top_range;
5020
5021 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5022 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5023 that many pixels tall. */
5024 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5025
5026 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5027 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5028 if (0 < start)
5029 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5030 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5031 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5032 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5033 inside_width, start,
5034 False);
5035
5036 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5037 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5038 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5039 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5040
5041 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5042 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5043 /* x, y, width, height */
5044 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5045 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5046 inside_width, end - start);
5047
5048 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5049 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5050 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5051 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5052
5053 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5054 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5055 if (end < inside_height)
5056 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5057 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5058 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5059 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5060 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5061 False);
5062
5063 }
5064
5065 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5066 }
5067
5068 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5069
5070 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5071 nil. */
5072
5073 static void
5074 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5075 {
5076 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5077 BLOCK_INPUT;
5078
5079 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5080 #ifdef USE_GTK
5081 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5082 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5083 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5084 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5085 #else
5086 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5087 #endif
5088
5089 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5090 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5091
5092 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5093 }
5094
5095
5096 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5097 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5098 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5099 create one. */
5100
5101 static void
5102 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5103 {
5104 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5105 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5106 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5107 int window_y, window_height;
5108 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5109 int fringe_extended_p;
5110 #endif
5111
5112 /* Get window dimensions. */
5113 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5114 top = window_y;
5115 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5116 height = window_height;
5117
5118 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5119 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5120
5121 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5122 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5123 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5124 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5125 else
5126 sb_width = width;
5127
5128 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5129 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5130 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5131 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5132 else
5133 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5134 #else
5135 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5136 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5137 else
5138 sb_left = left;
5139 #endif
5140
5141 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5142 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5143 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5144 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5145 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5146 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5147 else
5148 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5149 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5150 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5151 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5152 #endif
5153
5154 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5155 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5156 {
5157 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5158 {
5159 BLOCK_INPUT;
5160 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5161 if (fringe_extended_p)
5162 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5163 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5164 else
5165 #endif
5166 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5167 left, top, width, height, False);
5168 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5169 }
5170
5171 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5172 }
5173 else
5174 {
5175 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5176 unsigned int mask = 0;
5177
5178 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5179
5180 BLOCK_INPUT;
5181
5182 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5183 mask |= CWX;
5184 if (top != bar->top)
5185 mask |= CWY;
5186 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5187 mask |= CWWidth;
5188 if (height != bar->height)
5189 mask |= CWHeight;
5190
5191 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5192
5193 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5194 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5195 {
5196 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5197 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5198 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5199 {
5200 if (fringe_extended_p)
5201 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5202 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5203 else
5204 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5205 left, top, width, height, False);
5206 }
5207 #ifdef USE_GTK
5208 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5209 bar->x_window,
5210 top,
5211 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5212 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5213 max (height, 1));
5214 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5215 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5216 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5217 top,
5218 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5219 max (height, 1), 0);
5220 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5221 }
5222 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5223
5224 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5225 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5226 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5227 {
5228 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5229 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5230 height, False);
5231 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5232 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5233 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5234 height, False);
5235 }
5236
5237 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5238 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5239 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5240 example. */
5241 {
5242 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5243 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5244 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5245 {
5246 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5247 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5248 left + area_width - rest, top,
5249 rest, height, False);
5250 else
5251 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5252 left, top, rest, height, False);
5253 }
5254 }
5255
5256 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5257 if (mask)
5258 {
5259 XWindowChanges wc;
5260
5261 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5262 wc.y = top;
5263 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5264 wc.height = height;
5265 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5266 mask, &wc);
5267 }
5268
5269 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5270
5271 /* Remember new settings. */
5272 bar->left = sb_left;
5273 bar->top = top;
5274 bar->width = sb_width;
5275 bar->height = height;
5276
5277 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5278 }
5279
5280 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5281 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5282
5283 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5284 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5285 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5286 dragged. */
5287 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5288 {
5289 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5290
5291 if (whole == 0)
5292 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5293 else
5294 {
5295 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5296 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5297 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5298 }
5299 }
5300 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5301
5302 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5303 }
5304
5305
5306 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5307 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5308 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5309 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5310 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5311 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5312 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5313
5314 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5315 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5316 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5317
5318 static void
5319 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5320 {
5321 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5322 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5323 {
5324 Lisp_Object bar;
5325 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5326 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5327 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5328 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5329 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5330 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5331 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5332 }
5333 }
5334
5335
5336 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5337 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5338
5339 static void
5340 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5341 {
5342 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5343 struct frame *f;
5344
5345 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5346 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5347 abort ();
5348
5349 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5350
5351 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5352 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5353 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5354 {
5355 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5356 the lists. */
5357 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5358 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5359 return;
5360 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5361 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5362 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5363 else
5364 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5365 one or the other! */
5366 abort ();
5367 }
5368 else
5369 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5370
5371 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5372 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5373
5374 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5375 bar->prev = Qnil;
5376 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5377 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5378 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5379 }
5380
5381 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5382 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5383
5384 static void
5385 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5386 {
5387 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5388
5389 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5390
5391 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5392 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5393 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5394
5395 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5396 {
5397 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5398
5399 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5400
5401 next = b->next;
5402 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5403 }
5404
5405 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5406 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5407 }
5408
5409
5410 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5411 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5412 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5413
5414 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5415 mark bits. */
5416
5417 static void
5418 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5419 {
5420 Window w = bar->x_window;
5421 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5422 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5423 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5424
5425 BLOCK_INPUT;
5426
5427 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5428
5429 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5430 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5431 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5432 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5433
5434 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5435 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5436
5437 /* x, y, width, height */
5438 0, 0,
5439 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5440 bar->height - 1);
5441
5442 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5443 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5444 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5445 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5446
5447 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5448
5449 }
5450 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5451
5452 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5453 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5454
5455 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5456 mark bits. */
5457
5458
5459 static void
5460 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5461 {
5462 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5463 abort ();
5464
5465 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5466 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5467 emacs_event->modifiers
5468 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5469 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5470 event->xbutton.state)
5471 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5472 ? up_modifier
5473 : down_modifier));
5474 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5475 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5476 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5477 {
5478 int top_range
5479 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5480 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5481
5482 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5483 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5484
5485 if (y < bar->start)
5486 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5487 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5488 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5489 else
5490 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5491
5492 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5493 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5494 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5495 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5496 {
5497 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5498 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5499
5500 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5501 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5502 }
5503 #endif
5504
5505 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5506 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5507 }
5508 }
5509
5510 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5511
5512 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5513
5514 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5515 mark bits. */
5516
5517 static void
5518 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5519 {
5520 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5521
5522 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5523
5524 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5525 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5526
5527 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5528 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5529 {
5530 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5531 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5532
5533 if (new_start != bar->start)
5534 {
5535 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5536
5537 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5538 }
5539 }
5540 }
5541
5542 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5543
5544 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5545 on the scroll bar. */
5546
5547 static void
5548 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
5549 {
5550 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5551 Window w = bar->x_window;
5552 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5553 int win_x, win_y;
5554 Window dummy_window;
5555 int dummy_coord;
5556 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5557
5558 BLOCK_INPUT;
5559
5560 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5561 report that. */
5562 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5563
5564 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5565 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5566 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5567
5568 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5569 &win_x, &win_y,
5570
5571 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5572 &dummy_mask))
5573 ;
5574 else
5575 {
5576 int top_range
5577 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5578
5579 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5580
5581 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5582 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5583
5584 if (win_y < 0)
5585 win_y = 0;
5586 if (win_y > top_range)
5587 win_y = top_range;
5588
5589 *fp = f;
5590 *bar_window = bar->window;
5591
5592 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5593 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5594 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5595 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5596 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5597 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5598 else
5599 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5600
5601 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5602 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5603
5604 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5605 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5606 }
5607
5608 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5609
5610 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5611 }
5612
5613
5614 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5615 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5616 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5617 redraw them. */
5618
5619 void
5620 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5621 {
5622 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5623 Lisp_Object bar;
5624
5625 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5626 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5627 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5628 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5629 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5630 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5631 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5632 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5633 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5634 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5635 }
5636
5637 \f
5638 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5639
5640 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5641 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5642 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5643 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5644
5645 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5646 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5647
5648 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5649
5650 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5651 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5652
5653 static int temp_index;
5654 static short temp_buffer[100];
5655
5656 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5657 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5658 temp_index = 0; \
5659 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5660
5661 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5662 on a particular display. */
5663
5664 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5665
5666 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5667 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5668 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5669 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5670
5671 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5672
5673 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5674 do \
5675 { \
5676 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5677 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5678 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5679 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5680 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5681 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5682 } \
5683 while (0)
5684
5685 enum
5686 {
5687 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5688 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5689 X_EVENT_DROP
5690 };
5691
5692 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5693 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5694 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5695
5696 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5697 this event further.
5698 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5699
5700 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5701 static int
5702 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5703 {
5704 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5705 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5706 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5707 was created. */
5708
5709 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5710 event->xclient.window);
5711
5712 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5713 }
5714 #endif
5715
5716 #ifdef USE_GTK
5717 static int current_count;
5718 static int current_finish;
5719 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5720
5721 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5722 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5723 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5724 static GdkFilterReturn
5725 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5726 {
5727 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5728
5729 BLOCK_INPUT;
5730 if (current_count >= 0)
5731 {
5732 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5733
5734 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5735
5736 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5737 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5738 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5739 so we do it here. */
5740 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5741 && dpyinfo
5742 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5743 {
5744 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5745 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5746 }
5747 #endif
5748
5749 if (! dpyinfo)
5750 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5751 else
5752 current_count +=
5753 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5754 current_hold_quit);
5755 }
5756 else
5757 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5758
5759 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5760
5761 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5762 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5763
5764 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5765 }
5766 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5767
5768
5769 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5770
5771 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5772 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5773 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5774
5775 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5776
5777 static int
5778 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventp, int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5779 {
5780 union {
5781 struct input_event ie;
5782 struct selection_input_event sie;
5783 } inev;
5784 int count = 0;
5785 int do_help = 0;
5786 int nbytes = 0;
5787 struct frame *f = NULL;
5788 struct coding_system coding;
5789 XEvent event = *eventp;
5790 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5791
5792 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5793
5794 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5795 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5796 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5797
5798 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5799 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5800
5801 switch (event.type)
5802 {
5803 case ClientMessage:
5804 {
5805 if (event.xclient.message_type
5806 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5807 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5808 {
5809 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5810 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5811 {
5812 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5813 could be the shell widget window
5814 if the frame has no title bar. */
5815 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5816 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5817 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5818 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5819 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5820 #endif
5821 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5822 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5823 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5824 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5825 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5826 needed.
5827
5828 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5829 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5830 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5831 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5832 Emacs. */
5833
5834 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5835 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5836 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5837 if (f)
5838 {
5839 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5840 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5841 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5842 x_catch_errors (d);
5843 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5844 /* The ICCCM says this is
5845 the only valid choice. */
5846 RevertToParent,
5847 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5848 /* This is needed to detect the error
5849 if there is an error. */
5850 XSync (d, False);
5851 x_uncatch_errors ();
5852 }
5853 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5854 #endif /* 0 */
5855 goto done;
5856 }
5857
5858 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5859 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5860 {
5861 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5862 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5863 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5864 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5865 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5866 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5867 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5868 session manager and one for this. */
5869 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5870 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5871 #endif
5872 {
5873 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5874 event.xclient.window);
5875 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5876 for a single Emacs process. */
5877 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5878 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5879 event.xclient.window,
5880 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5881 else if (f)
5882 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5883 event.xclient.window,
5884 0, 0);
5885 }
5886 goto done;
5887 }
5888
5889 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5890 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5891 {
5892 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5893 event.xclient.window);
5894 if (!f)
5895 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5896
5897 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5898 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5899 goto done;
5900 }
5901
5902 goto done;
5903 }
5904
5905 if (event.xclient.message_type
5906 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5907 {
5908 goto done;
5909 }
5910
5911 if (event.xclient.message_type
5912 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5913 {
5914 int new_x, new_y;
5915 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5916
5917 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5918 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5919
5920 if (f)
5921 {
5922 f->left_pos = new_x;
5923 f->top_pos = new_y;
5924 }
5925 goto done;
5926 }
5927
5928 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5929 if (event.xclient.message_type
5930 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5931 {
5932 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5933 if (f)
5934 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5935 &event, NULL);
5936 goto done;
5937 }
5938 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5939
5940 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5941 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5942 || (event.xclient.message_type
5943 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5944 {
5945 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5946 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5947 currently never do because we are interested in
5948 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5949 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5950 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5951 if (!f)
5952 goto OTHER;
5953 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5954 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5955 goto done;
5956 }
5957
5958 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5959 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5960 we construct an input_event. */
5961 if (event.xclient.message_type
5962 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5963 {
5964 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5965 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5966 goto done;
5967 }
5968 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5969
5970 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5971 if (event.xclient.message_type
5972 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
5973 {
5974 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
5975 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
5976 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
5977
5978 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5979 goto done;
5980 }
5981
5982 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
5983
5984 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5985 if (!f)
5986 goto OTHER;
5987 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5988 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5989 }
5990 break;
5991
5992 case SelectionNotify:
5993 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
5994 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5995 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5996 goto OTHER;
5997 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5998 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5999 break;
6000
6001 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6002 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6003 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6004 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6005 goto OTHER;
6006 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6007 {
6008 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
6009
6010 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6011 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6012 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6013 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6014 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6015 }
6016 break;
6017
6018 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6019 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6020 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6021 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6022 goto OTHER;
6023 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6024 {
6025 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
6026 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
6027
6028 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6029 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6030 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6031 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6032 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6033 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6034 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6035 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6036 }
6037 break;
6038
6039 case PropertyNotify:
6040 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6041 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6042 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6043 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
6044
6045 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6046 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6047 goto OTHER;
6048
6049 case ReparentNotify:
6050 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6051 if (f)
6052 {
6053 int x, y;
6054 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6055 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6056 f->left_pos = x;
6057 f->top_pos = y;
6058
6059 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6060 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6061 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6062 }
6063 goto OTHER;
6064
6065 case Expose:
6066 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6067 if (f)
6068 {
6069 #ifdef USE_GTK
6070 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6071 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6072 event.xexpose.window,
6073 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6074 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6075 FALSE);
6076 #endif
6077 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6078 {
6079 f->async_visible = 1;
6080 f->async_iconified = 0;
6081 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6082 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6083 }
6084 else
6085 expose_frame (f,
6086 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6087 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6088 }
6089 else
6090 {
6091 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6092 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6093 #endif
6094 #if defined USE_LUCID
6095 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6096 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6097 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6098 {
6099 Widget widget
6100 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6101 if (widget)
6102 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6103 }
6104 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6105
6106 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6107 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6108 goto OTHER;
6109 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6110 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6111 event.xexpose.window);
6112
6113 if (bar)
6114 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6115 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6116 else
6117 goto OTHER;
6118 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6119 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6120 }
6121 break;
6122
6123 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6124 source area was obscured or not
6125 available. */
6126 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6127 if (f)
6128 {
6129 expose_frame (f,
6130 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6131 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6132 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6133 }
6134 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6135 else
6136 goto OTHER;
6137 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6138 break;
6139
6140 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6141 source area was completely
6142 available. */
6143 break;
6144
6145 case UnmapNotify:
6146 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6147 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6148 {
6149 tip_window = 0;
6150 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6151 }
6152
6153 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6154 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6155 the frame was deleted. */
6156 {
6157 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6158 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6159 display that won't ever be seen. */
6160 f->async_visible = 0;
6161 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6162 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6163 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6164 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6165 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6166 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6167 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6168 {
6169 f->async_iconified = 1;
6170
6171 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6172 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6173 }
6174 }
6175 goto OTHER;
6176
6177 case MapNotify:
6178 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6179 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6180 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6181 goto OTHER;
6182
6183 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6184 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6185 frame is visible. */
6186 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6187 if (f)
6188 {
6189 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6190 the frame's display structures.
6191 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6192 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6193 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6194 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6195 if (! f->async_iconified)
6196 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6197
6198 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6199 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6200 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6201 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6202
6203 f->async_visible = 1;
6204 f->async_iconified = 0;
6205 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6206
6207 if (f->iconified)
6208 {
6209 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6210 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6211 }
6212 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6213 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6214 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6215 to update the frame titles
6216 in case this is the second frame. */
6217 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6218
6219 #ifdef USE_GTK
6220 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6221 #endif
6222 }
6223 goto OTHER;
6224
6225 case KeyPress:
6226
6227 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6228 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6229
6230 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6231 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6232 if (popup_activated ())
6233 goto OTHER;
6234 #endif
6235
6236 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6237
6238 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6239 mouse highlighting. */
6240 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6241 && (f == 0
6242 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6243 {
6244 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6245 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6246 }
6247
6248 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6249 if (f == 0)
6250 {
6251 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6252 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6253 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6254 event.xkey.window);
6255 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6256 {
6257 widget = XtParent (widget);
6258 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6259 }
6260 }
6261 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6262
6263 if (f != 0)
6264 {
6265 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6266 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6267 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6268 his Emacs hang.
6269
6270 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6271 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6272 status_return even if the input is too long to
6273 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6274 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6275 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6276 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6277 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6278 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6279 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6280 int modifiers;
6281 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6282 Lisp_Object c;
6283
6284 #ifdef USE_GTK
6285 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6286 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6287 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6288 (see above). */
6289 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6290 #endif
6291
6292 event.xkey.state
6293 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6294 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6295 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6296
6297 /* This will have to go some day... */
6298
6299 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6300 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6301 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6302 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6303 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6304 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6305 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6306
6307 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6308 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6309 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6310 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6311 not it is combined with Meta. */
6312 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6313 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6314
6315 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6316 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6317 {
6318 Status status_return;
6319
6320 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6321 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6322 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6323 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6324 &status_return);
6325 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6326 {
6327 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6328 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6329 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6330 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6331 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6332 &status_return);
6333 }
6334 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6335 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6336 break;
6337 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6338 {
6339 keysym = NoSymbol;
6340 modifiers = 0;
6341 }
6342 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6343 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6344 abort ();
6345 }
6346 else
6347 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6348 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6349 &compose_status);
6350 #else
6351 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6352 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6353 &compose_status);
6354 #endif
6355
6356 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6357 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6358 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6359 break;
6360
6361 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6362 orig_keysym = keysym;
6363
6364 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6365 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6366 inev.ie.modifiers
6367 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6368 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6369
6370 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6371 translations to characters. */
6372 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6373 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6374 {
6375 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6376 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6377 goto done_keysym;
6378 }
6379
6380 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6381 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6382 {
6383 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6384 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6385 else
6386 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6387 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6388 goto done_keysym;
6389 }
6390
6391 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6392 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6393 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6394 Vx_keysym_table,
6395 Qnil))))
6396 {
6397 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6398 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6399 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6400 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6401 goto done_keysym;
6402 }
6403
6404 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6405 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6406 || keysym == XK_Delete
6407 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6408 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6409 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6410 #endif
6411 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6412 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6413 #ifdef HPUX
6414 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6415 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6416 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6417 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6418 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6419 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6420 #endif
6421 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6422 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6423 #endif
6424 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6425 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6426 #endif
6427 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6428 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6429 #endif
6430 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6431 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6432 #endif
6433 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6434 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6435 #endif
6436 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6437 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6438 #endif
6439 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6440 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6441 #endif
6442 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6443 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6444 #endif
6445 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6446 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6447 #endif
6448 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6449 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6450 #endif
6451 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6452 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6453 #endif
6454 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6455 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6456 #endif
6457 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6458 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6459 #endif
6460 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6461 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6462 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6463 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6464 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6465 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6466 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6467 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6468 don't have real modifiers but
6469 should be treated similarly to
6470 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6471 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6472 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6473 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6474 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6475 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6476 #endif
6477 ))
6478 {
6479 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6480 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6481 key. */
6482 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6483 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6484 goto done_keysym;
6485 }
6486
6487 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6488 register int i;
6489 register int c;
6490 int nchars, len;
6491
6492 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6493 {
6494 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6495 nchars++;
6496 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6497 }
6498
6499 if (nchars < nbytes)
6500 {
6501 /* Decode the input data. */
6502 int require;
6503 unsigned char *p;
6504
6505 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6506 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6507 we used just above and the locale. */
6508 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6509 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6510 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6511 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6512 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6513 gives us composition information. */
6514 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6515
6516 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6517 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6518 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6519 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6520 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6521 nbytes = coding.produced;
6522 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6523 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6524 }
6525
6526 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6527 character events. */
6528 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6529 {
6530 if (nchars == nbytes)
6531 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6532 else
6533 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6534 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6535 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6536 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6537 inev.ie.code = c;
6538 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6539 }
6540
6541 count += nchars;
6542
6543 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6544
6545 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6546 break;
6547 }
6548 }
6549 done_keysym:
6550 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6551 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6552 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6553 client. */
6554 break;
6555 #else
6556 goto OTHER;
6557 #endif
6558
6559 case KeyRelease:
6560 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6561 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6562 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6563 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6564 client. */
6565 break;
6566 #else
6567 goto OTHER;
6568 #endif
6569
6570 case EnterNotify:
6571 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6572 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6573
6574 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6575
6576 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6577 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6578
6579 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6580 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6581 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6582 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6583 #ifdef USE_GTK
6584 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6585 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6586 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6587 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6588 #endif
6589 goto OTHER;
6590
6591 case FocusIn:
6592 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6593 goto OTHER;
6594
6595 case LeaveNotify:
6596 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6597 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6598
6599 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6600 if (f)
6601 {
6602 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6603 {
6604 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6605 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6606 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6607 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6608 }
6609
6610 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6611 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6612 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6613 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6614 if (any_help_event_p)
6615 do_help = -1;
6616 }
6617 #ifdef USE_GTK
6618 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6619 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6620 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6621 #endif
6622 goto OTHER;
6623
6624 case FocusOut:
6625 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6626 goto OTHER;
6627
6628 case MotionNotify:
6629 {
6630 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6631 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6632 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6633
6634 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6635 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6636 f = last_mouse_frame;
6637 else
6638 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6639
6640 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6641 {
6642 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6643 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6644 }
6645
6646 #ifdef USE_GTK
6647 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6648 f = 0;
6649 #endif
6650 if (f)
6651 {
6652
6653 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6654 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6655 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6656 {
6657 Lisp_Object window;
6658
6659 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6660 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6661 0, 0);
6662
6663 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6664 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6665 will be selected only when it is active. */
6666 if (WINDOWP (window)
6667 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6668 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6669 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6670 create event iff we don't leave the
6671 selected frame. */
6672 && (focus_follows_mouse
6673 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6674 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6675 {
6676 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6677 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6678 }
6679
6680 last_window=window;
6681 }
6682 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6683 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6684 }
6685 else
6686 {
6687 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6688 struct scroll_bar *bar
6689 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6690 event.xmotion.window);
6691
6692 if (bar)
6693 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6694 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6695
6696 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6697 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6698 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6699 }
6700
6701 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6702 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6703 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6704 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6705 do_help = 1;
6706 goto OTHER;
6707 }
6708
6709 case ConfigureNotify:
6710 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6711 #ifdef USE_GTK
6712 if (!f
6713 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6714 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6715 {
6716 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6717 event.xconfigure.height);
6718 f = 0;
6719 }
6720 #endif
6721 if (f)
6722 {
6723 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6724 #ifndef USE_GTK
6725 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6726 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6727
6728 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6729 is called by the code that handles resizing
6730 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6731
6732 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6733 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6734 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6735 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6736 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6737 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6738 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6739 {
6740 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6741 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6742 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6743 }
6744
6745 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6746 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6747 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6748 #endif
6749
6750 #ifdef USE_GTK
6751 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6752 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6753 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6754 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6755 #endif
6756 {
6757 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6758 }
6759
6760 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6761 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6762 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6763 #endif
6764
6765 }
6766 goto OTHER;
6767
6768 case ButtonRelease:
6769 case ButtonPress:
6770 {
6771 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6772 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6773 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6774
6775 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6776 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6777 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6778
6779 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6780 && last_mouse_frame
6781 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6782 f = last_mouse_frame;
6783 else
6784 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6785
6786 #ifdef USE_GTK
6787 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6788 f = 0;
6789 #endif
6790 if (f)
6791 {
6792 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6793 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6794 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6795 {
6796 Lisp_Object window;
6797 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6798 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6799
6800 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6801 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6802
6803 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6804 {
6805 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6806 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6807 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6808 event.xbutton.state));
6809 }
6810 }
6811
6812 if (!tool_bar_p)
6813 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6814 if (! popup_activated ())
6815 #endif
6816 {
6817 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6818 {
6819 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6820 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6821 {
6822 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6823 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6824 }
6825 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6826 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6827 }
6828 else
6829 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6830 }
6831 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6832 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6833 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6834 }
6835 else
6836 {
6837 struct scroll_bar *bar
6838 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6839 event.xbutton.window);
6840
6841 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6842 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6843 scroll bars. */
6844 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6845 {
6846 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6847 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6848 }
6849 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6850 if (bar)
6851 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6852 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6853 }
6854
6855 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6856 {
6857 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6858 last_mouse_frame = f;
6859
6860 if (!tool_bar_p)
6861 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6862 }
6863 else
6864 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6865
6866 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6867 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6868 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6869 if (f != 0)
6870 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6871
6872 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6873 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6874 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6875 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6876 Instead, save it away
6877 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6878 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6879 if (! popup_activated ()
6880 #ifdef USE_GTK
6881 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6882 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6883 #endif
6884 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6885 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6886 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6887 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6888 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6889 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6890 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6891 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6892 {
6893 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6894 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6895 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6896 }
6897 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6898 {
6899 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6900 goto OTHER;
6901 }
6902 else
6903 goto OTHER;
6904 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6905 }
6906 break;
6907
6908 case CirculateNotify:
6909 goto OTHER;
6910
6911 case CirculateRequest:
6912 goto OTHER;
6913
6914 case VisibilityNotify:
6915 goto OTHER;
6916
6917 case MappingNotify:
6918 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6919 local cache. */
6920 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6921 {
6922 case MappingModifier:
6923 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6924 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6925 case MappingKeyboard:
6926 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6927 }
6928 goto OTHER;
6929
6930 case DestroyNotify:
6931 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6932 break;
6933
6934 default:
6935 OTHER:
6936 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6937 BLOCK_INPUT;
6938 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6939 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6940 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6941 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6942 break;
6943 }
6944
6945 done:
6946 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6947 {
6948 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6949 count++;
6950 }
6951
6952 if (do_help
6953 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6954 {
6955 Lisp_Object frame;
6956
6957 if (f)
6958 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6959 else
6960 frame = Qnil;
6961
6962 if (do_help > 0)
6963 {
6964 any_help_event_p = 1;
6965 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6966 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6967 }
6968 else
6969 {
6970 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6971 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6972 }
6973 count++;
6974 }
6975
6976 *eventp = event;
6977 return count;
6978 }
6979
6980
6981 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6982 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6983 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6984
6985 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6986 int
6987 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
6988 {
6989 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6990 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6991
6992 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6993
6994 if (dpyinfo)
6995 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6996
6997 return finish;
6998 }
6999
7000
7001 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7002 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7003 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7004
7005 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7006 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7007 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7008 C chars).
7009
7010 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7011
7012 static int
7013 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7014 {
7015 int count = 0;
7016 XEvent event;
7017 int event_found = 0;
7018
7019 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7020 {
7021 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7022 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7023 pending_signals = 1;
7024 #endif
7025 return -1;
7026 }
7027
7028 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7029 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7030 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7031 #endif
7032 BLOCK_INPUT;
7033
7034 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7035 input_signal_count++;
7036
7037 ++handling_signal;
7038
7039 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7040 /* Only check session manager input for the primary display. */
7041 if (terminal->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
7042 {
7043 struct input_event inev;
7044 BLOCK_INPUT;
7045 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7046 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7047 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7048 {
7049 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7050 count++;
7051 }
7052 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7053 }
7054 #endif
7055
7056 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7057 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7058 {
7059 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7060 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7061 }
7062
7063 #ifndef USE_GTK
7064 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7065 {
7066 int finish;
7067
7068 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7069
7070 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7071 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7072 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7073 continue;
7074 #endif
7075 event_found = 1;
7076
7077 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7078 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7079
7080 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7081 goto out;
7082 }
7083
7084 #else /* USE_GTK */
7085
7086 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7087 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7088 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7089 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7090
7091 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7092 from all displays. */
7093
7094 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7095 {
7096 current_count = count;
7097 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7098
7099 gtk_main_iteration ();
7100
7101 count = current_count;
7102 current_count = -1;
7103 current_hold_quit = 0;
7104
7105 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7106 break;
7107 }
7108 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7109
7110 out:;
7111
7112 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7113 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7114 if (! event_found)
7115 {
7116 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7117 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7118 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7119 x_noop_count++;
7120 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7121 {
7122 x_noop_count=0;
7123
7124 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7125 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7126
7127 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7128
7129 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7130 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7131 }
7132 }
7133
7134 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7135 raise it now. */
7136 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7137 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7138 {
7139 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7140 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7141 }
7142
7143 --handling_signal;
7144 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7145
7146 return count;
7147 }
7148
7149
7150
7151 \f
7152 /***********************************************************************
7153 Text Cursor
7154 ***********************************************************************/
7155
7156 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7157 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7158
7159 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7160 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7161 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7162
7163 static void
7164 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7165 {
7166 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7167 XRectangle clip_rect;
7168 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7169
7170 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7171
7172 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7173 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7174 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7175 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7176 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7177
7178 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7179 }
7180
7181
7182 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7183
7184 static void
7185 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7186 {
7187 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7188 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7189 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7190 int x, y, wd, h;
7191 XGCValues xgcv;
7192 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7193 GC gc;
7194
7195 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7196 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7197 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7198 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7199 return;
7200
7201 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7202 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7203 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7204
7205 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7206 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7207 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7208 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7209 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7210 else
7211 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7212 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7213 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7214
7215 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7216 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7217 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7218 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7219 }
7220
7221
7222 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7223
7224 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7225 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7226 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7227 --gerd. */
7228
7229 static void
7230 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7231 {
7232 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7233 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7234
7235 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7236 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7237 and mini-buffer. */
7238 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7239 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7240 return;
7241
7242 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7243 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7244 the bar might not be in the window. */
7245 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7246 {
7247 struct glyph_row *row;
7248 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7249 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7250 }
7251 else
7252 {
7253 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7254 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7255 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7256 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7257 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7258 XGCValues xgcv;
7259
7260 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7261 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7262 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7263 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7264 that the glyph is legible. */
7265 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7266 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7267 else
7268 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7269 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7270
7271 if (gc)
7272 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7273 else
7274 {
7275 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7276 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7277 }
7278
7279 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7280
7281 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7282 {
7283 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7284
7285 if (width < 0)
7286 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7287 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7288
7289 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7290
7291 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7292 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7293 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7294 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7295
7296 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7297 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7298 width, row->height);
7299 }
7300 else
7301 {
7302 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7303
7304 if (width < 0)
7305 width = row->height;
7306
7307 width = min (row->height, width);
7308
7309 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7310 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7311
7312 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7313 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7314 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7315 row->height - width),
7316 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7317 }
7318
7319 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7320 }
7321 }
7322
7323
7324 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7325
7326 static void
7327 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7328 {
7329 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7330 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7331 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7332 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7333 }
7334
7335
7336 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7337
7338 static void
7339 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7340 {
7341 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7342 x, y, width, height, False);
7343 #ifdef USE_GTK
7344 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7345 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7346 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7347 #endif
7348 }
7349
7350
7351 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7352
7353 static void
7354 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7355 {
7356 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7357
7358 if (on_p)
7359 {
7360 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7361 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7362
7363 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7364 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7365 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7366 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7367 {
7368 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7369 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7370 }
7371 else
7372 {
7373 switch (cursor_type)
7374 {
7375 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7376 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7377 break;
7378
7379 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7380 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7381 break;
7382
7383 case BAR_CURSOR:
7384 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7385 break;
7386
7387 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7388 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7389 break;
7390
7391 case NO_CURSOR:
7392 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7393 break;
7394
7395 default:
7396 abort ();
7397 }
7398 }
7399
7400 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7401 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7402 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7403 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7404 #endif
7405 }
7406
7407 #ifndef XFlush
7408 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7409 #endif
7410 }
7411
7412 \f
7413 /* Icons. */
7414
7415 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7416
7417 int
7418 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7419 {
7420 int bitmap_id;
7421
7422 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7423 return 1;
7424
7425 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7426 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7427 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7428 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7429
7430 if (STRINGP (file))
7431 {
7432 #ifdef USE_GTK
7433 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7434 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7435 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7436 return 0;
7437 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7438 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7439 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7440 }
7441 else
7442 {
7443 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7444 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7445 {
7446 int rc = -1;
7447
7448 #ifdef USE_GTK
7449
7450 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7451 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7452 return 0;
7453
7454 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7455
7456 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7457 if (rc != -1)
7458 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7459
7460 #endif
7461
7462 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7463 if (rc == -1)
7464 {
7465 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7466 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7467 if (rc == -1)
7468 return 1;
7469
7470 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7471 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7472 }
7473 }
7474
7475 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7476 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7477 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7478 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7479 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7480
7481 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7482 }
7483
7484 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7485 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7486
7487 return 0;
7488 }
7489
7490
7491 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7492 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7493
7494 int
7495 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7496 {
7497 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7498 return 1;
7499
7500 {
7501 XTextProperty text;
7502 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7503 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7504 text.format = 8;
7505 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7506 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7507 }
7508
7509 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7510 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7511 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7512 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7513
7514 return 0;
7515 }
7516 \f
7517 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7518
7519 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7520 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7521
7522 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7523 be called from a signal handler.
7524 */
7525
7526 struct x_error_message_stack {
7527 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7528 Display *dpy;
7529 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7530 };
7531 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7532
7533 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7534 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7535 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7536
7537 static void
7538 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7539 {
7540 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7541 x_error_message->string,
7542 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7543 }
7544
7545 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7546 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7547 operating on.
7548
7549 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7550 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7551 stored in *x_error_message.
7552
7553 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7554 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7555
7556 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7557
7558 void x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format);
7559
7560 void
7561 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7562 {
7563 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7564
7565 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7566 XSync (dpy, False);
7567
7568 data->dpy = dpy;
7569 data->string[0] = 0;
7570 data->prev = x_error_message;
7571 x_error_message = data;
7572 }
7573
7574 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7575 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7576
7577 void
7578 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7579 {
7580 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7581
7582 BLOCK_INPUT;
7583
7584 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7585 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7586 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7587 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7588
7589 tmp = x_error_message;
7590 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7591 xfree (tmp);
7592 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7593 }
7594
7595 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7596 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7597 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7598
7599 void
7600 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7601 {
7602 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7603 XSync (dpy, False);
7604
7605 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7606 {
7607 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7608 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7609 x_uncatch_errors ();
7610 error (format, string);
7611 }
7612 }
7613
7614 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7615 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7616
7617 int
7618 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7619 {
7620 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7621 XSync (dpy, False);
7622
7623 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7624 }
7625
7626 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7627
7628 void
7629 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7630 {
7631 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7632 }
7633
7634 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7635 * idea. --lorentey */
7636 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7637
7638 void
7639 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7640 {
7641 while (x_error_message)
7642 x_uncatch_errors ();
7643 }
7644 #endif
7645
7646 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7647
7648 int
7649 x_catching_errors (void)
7650 {
7651 return x_error_message != 0;
7652 }
7653
7654 #if 0
7655 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7656 x_trace_wire (void)
7657 {
7658 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7659 }
7660 #endif /* ! 0 */
7661
7662 \f
7663 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7664 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7665 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7666 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7667 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7668
7669 static SIGTYPE
7670 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7671 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7672 {
7673 #ifdef USG
7674 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7675 must reestablish each time */
7676 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7677 #endif /* USG */
7678 }
7679
7680 \f
7681 /************************************************************************
7682 Handling X errors
7683 ************************************************************************/
7684
7685 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7686
7687 static char *error_msg;
7688
7689 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7690 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7691 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7692
7693 static void
7694 x_fatal_error_signal (void)
7695 {
7696 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7697 exit (70);
7698 }
7699
7700 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7701 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7702
7703 static SIGTYPE
7704 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7705 {
7706 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7707 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7708 int index = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7709
7710 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7711 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7712 handling_signal = 0;
7713
7714 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7715 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7716 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7717 the original message here. */
7718 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7719
7720 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7721 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7722
7723 if (dpyinfo)
7724 {
7725 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7726 frame on it. */
7727 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7728 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7729 }
7730
7731 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7732 that are on the dead display. */
7733 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7734 {
7735 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7736 minibuf_frame
7737 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7738 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7739 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7740 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7741 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7742 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7743 }
7744
7745 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7746 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7747 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7748 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7749 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7750 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7751 {
7752 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7753 trying to find a replacement. */
7754 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7755 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7756 }
7757
7758 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7759 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7760 if (dpyinfo)
7761 {
7762 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7763 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7764 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7765 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7766
7767 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7768 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7769 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7770
7771 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1',
7772 opened in the first call to make-frame-on-display.
7773
7774 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7775 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7776 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to circumvent it here. */
7777 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7778 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7779 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7780 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7781
7782 #ifdef USE_GTK
7783 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7784 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7785 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7786 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7787 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7788 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7789 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7790 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7791 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7792 error_msg);
7793 abort ();
7794 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7795
7796 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7797 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7798
7799 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7800 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7801 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7802 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7803 abort ();
7804
7805 {
7806 Lisp_Object tmp;
7807 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7808 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7809 }
7810 }
7811
7812 x_uncatch_errors ();
7813
7814 if (terminal_list == 0)
7815 {
7816 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7817 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7818 /* NOTREACHED */
7819 }
7820
7821 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7822 #ifdef SIGIO
7823 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7824 #endif
7825 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7826 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7827
7828 unbind_to (index, Qnil);
7829 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7830 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7831 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7832 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7833 error ("%s", error_msg);
7834 }
7835
7836 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7837 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7838 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7839
7840 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7841 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7842
7843 static int
7844 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7845 {
7846 if (x_error_message)
7847 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7848 else
7849 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7850 return 0;
7851 }
7852
7853 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7854 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7855 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7856
7857 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7858
7859 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7860 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7861
7862 static void NO_INLINE
7863 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7864 {
7865 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7866
7867 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7868 or colors that are not defined. */
7869
7870 if (error->error_code == BadName)
7871 return;
7872
7873 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7874 original error handler. */
7875
7876 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7877 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7878 buf, error->request_code);
7879 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7880 }
7881
7882
7883 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7884 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7885 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7886
7887 static int
7888 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7889 {
7890 char buf[256];
7891
7892 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7893 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7894 return 0;
7895 }
7896 \f
7897 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7898
7899 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7900 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7901 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7902 FONT-OBJECT. */
7903
7904 Lisp_Object
7905 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7906 {
7907 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7908
7909 if (fontset < 0)
7910 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7911 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7912 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7913 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7914 do. */
7915 return font_object;
7916
7917 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7918 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7919 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7920 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7921 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7922
7923 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7924
7925 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7926 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7927 {
7928 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7929 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7930 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7931 }
7932 else
7933 {
7934 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7935 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7936 }
7937
7938 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7939 {
7940 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7941 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7942 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7943 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7944 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7945 }
7946
7947 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7948 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7949 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7950 {
7951 BLOCK_INPUT;
7952 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7953 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7954 }
7955 #endif
7956
7957 return font_object;
7958 }
7959
7960 \f
7961 /***********************************************************************
7962 X Input Methods
7963 ***********************************************************************/
7964
7965 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7966
7967 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7968
7969 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7970 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7971 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7972
7973 static void
7974 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7975 {
7976 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7977 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7978
7979 BLOCK_INPUT;
7980
7981 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7982 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7983 {
7984 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7985 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7986 {
7987 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7988 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7989 }
7990 }
7991
7992 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7993 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7994 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7995 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7996 }
7997
7998 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7999
8000 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8001 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8002 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8003 #endif
8004
8005 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8006 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8007
8008 static void
8009 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8010 {
8011 XIM xim;
8012
8013 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8014 if (use_xim)
8015 {
8016 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8017 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8018 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8019 emacs_class);
8020 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8021
8022 if (xim)
8023 {
8024 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8025 XIMCallback destroy;
8026 #endif
8027
8028 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8029 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8030
8031 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8032 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8033 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8034 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8035 #endif
8036 }
8037 }
8038
8039 else
8040 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8041 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8042 }
8043
8044
8045 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8046
8047 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8048 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8049 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8050 when the callback was registered. */
8051
8052 static void
8053 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8054 {
8055 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8056 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8057
8058 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8059 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8060 return;
8061
8062 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8063
8064 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8065 as they have no XIC. */
8066 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8067 {
8068 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8069
8070 BLOCK_INPUT;
8071 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8072 {
8073 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8074
8075 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8076 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8077 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8078 {
8079 create_frame_xic (f);
8080 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8081 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8082 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8083 {
8084 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8085 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8086 }
8087 }
8088 }
8089
8090 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8091 }
8092 }
8093
8094 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8095
8096
8097 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8098 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8099 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8100 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8101
8102 static void
8103 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8104 {
8105 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8106 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8107 if (use_xim)
8108 {
8109 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8110 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8111 int len;
8112
8113 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8114 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8115 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8116 len = strlen (resource_name);
8117 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8118 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8119 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8120 resource_name, emacs_class,
8121 xim_instantiate_callback,
8122 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8123 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8124 least, hence the configure test. */
8125 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8126 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8127 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8128 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8129 }
8130 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8131 }
8132
8133
8134 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8135
8136 static void
8137 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8138 {
8139 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8140 if (use_xim)
8141 {
8142 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8143 if (dpyinfo->display)
8144 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8145 NULL, emacs_class,
8146 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8147 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8148 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8149 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8150 if (dpyinfo->display)
8151 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8152 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8153 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8154 }
8155 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8156 }
8157
8158 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8159
8160
8161 \f
8162 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8163 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8164
8165 void
8166 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8167 {
8168 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8169
8170 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8171 is already for the top-left corner. */
8172 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8173 return;
8174
8175 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8176 position that fits on the screen. */
8177 if (flags & XNegative)
8178 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8179 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8180
8181 {
8182 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8183
8184 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8185 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8186 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8187
8188 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8189 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8190 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8191 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8192 is right, though.
8193
8194 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8195 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8196
8197 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8198 #endif
8199
8200 if (flags & YNegative)
8201 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8202 - height + f->top_pos;
8203 }
8204
8205 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8206 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8207 so the flags should correspond. */
8208 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8209 }
8210
8211 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8212 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8213 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8214 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8215 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8216
8217 void
8218 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8219 {
8220 int modified_top, modified_left;
8221
8222 if (change_gravity > 0)
8223 {
8224 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8225 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8226
8227 f->top_pos = yoff;
8228 f->left_pos = xoff;
8229 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8230 if (xoff < 0)
8231 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8232 if (yoff < 0)
8233 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8234 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8235 }
8236 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8237
8238 BLOCK_INPUT;
8239 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8240
8241 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8242 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8243
8244 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8245 {
8246 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8247 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8248 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8249 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8250 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8251 }
8252
8253 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8254 modified_left, modified_top);
8255
8256 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8257 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8258 ? 1 : 0);
8259
8260 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8261 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8262 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8263 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8264 of the frame.
8265
8266 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8267 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8268 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8269
8270 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8271 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8272 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8273 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8274 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8275 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8276
8277 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8278 }
8279
8280 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8281 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8282 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8283 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8284 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8285
8286 static int
8287 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8288 {
8289 Atom actual_type;
8290 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8291 int i, rc, actual_format;
8292 Window wmcheck_window;
8293 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8294 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8295 long max_len = 65536;
8296 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8297 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8298 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8299
8300 BLOCK_INPUT;
8301
8302 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8303 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8304 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8305 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8306 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8307 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8308
8309 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8310 {
8311 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8312 x_uncatch_errors ();
8313 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8314 return 0;
8315 }
8316
8317 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8318 XFree (tmp_data);
8319
8320 /* Check if window exists. */
8321 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8322 x_sync (f);
8323 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8324 {
8325 x_uncatch_errors ();
8326 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8327 return 0;
8328 }
8329
8330 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8331 {
8332 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8333 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8334 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8335 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8336 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8337 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8338
8339 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8340 tmp_data = NULL;
8341 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8342 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8343 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8344 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8345 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8346
8347 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8348 {
8349 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8350 x_uncatch_errors ();
8351 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8352 return 0;
8353 }
8354
8355 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8356 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8357 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8358 }
8359
8360 rc = 0;
8361
8362 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8363 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8364
8365 x_uncatch_errors ();
8366 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8367
8368 return rc;
8369 }
8370
8371 static void
8372 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8373 {
8374 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8375
8376 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8377 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8378 make_number (32),
8379 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8380 Fcons
8381 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8382 Fcons
8383 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8384 value != 0
8385 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8386 : Qnil)));
8387 }
8388
8389 void
8390 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8391 {
8392 Lisp_Object frame;
8393 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8394
8395 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8396
8397 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8398 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8399 }
8400
8401 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8402 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8403 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not. */
8404
8405 static void
8406 get_current_vm_state (struct frame *f,
8407 Window window,
8408 int *size_state,
8409 int *sticky)
8410 {
8411 Atom actual_type;
8412 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8413 int i, rc, actual_format;
8414 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8415 long max_len = 65536;
8416 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8417 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8418 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8419
8420 *sticky = 0;
8421 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8422
8423 BLOCK_INPUT;
8424 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8425 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8426 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8427 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8428 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8429
8430 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8431 {
8432 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8433 x_uncatch_errors ();
8434 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8435 return;
8436 }
8437
8438 x_uncatch_errors ();
8439
8440 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8441 {
8442 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8443 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8444 {
8445 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8446 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8447 else
8448 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8449 }
8450 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8451 {
8452 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8453 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8454 else
8455 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8456 }
8457 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8458 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8459 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8460 *sticky = 1;
8461 }
8462
8463 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8464 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8465 }
8466
8467 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8468
8469 static int
8470 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8471 {
8472 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8473 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8474 Lisp_Object lval = get_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen);
8475 int cur, dummy;
8476
8477 get_current_vm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8478
8479 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8480 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8481 if (!have_net_atom)
8482 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8483
8484 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8485 {
8486 Lisp_Object frame;
8487
8488 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8489
8490 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8491 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8492 are sent at once. */
8493 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8494 {
8495 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8496 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8497 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8498 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8499 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8500 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8501 break;
8502 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8503 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8504 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8505 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8506 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8507 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8508 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8509 break;
8510 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8511 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8512 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8513 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8514 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8515 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8516 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8517 break;
8518 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8519 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8520 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8521 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8522 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8523 break;
8524 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8525 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8526 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8527 else
8528 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8529 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8530 }
8531
8532 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8533
8534 }
8535
8536 return have_net_atom;
8537 }
8538
8539 static void
8540 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8541 {
8542 if (f->async_visible)
8543 {
8544 BLOCK_INPUT;
8545 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8546 x_sync (f);
8547 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8548 }
8549 }
8550
8551
8552 static void
8553 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8554 {
8555 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8556 Lisp_Object lval;
8557 int sticky = 0;
8558
8559 get_current_vm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8560 lval = Qnil;
8561 switch (value)
8562 {
8563 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8564 lval = Qfullwidth;
8565 break;
8566 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8567 lval = Qfullheight;
8568 break;
8569 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8570 lval = Qfullboth;
8571 break;
8572 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8573 lval = Qmaximized;
8574 break;
8575 }
8576
8577 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8578 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8579 }
8580
8581 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8582 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8583 static void
8584 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8585 {
8586 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8587 return;
8588
8589 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8590 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8591
8592 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8593 {
8594 int width = FRAME_COLS (f), height = FRAME_LINES (f);
8595 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8596
8597 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8598 {
8599 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8600 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8601 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8602 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8603 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8604 break;
8605 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8606 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8607 break;
8608 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8609 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8610 }
8611
8612 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8613 {
8614 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8615 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8616 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8617 }
8618 }
8619 }
8620
8621 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8622 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8623 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8624 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8625 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8626 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8627 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8628
8629 static void
8630 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8631 {
8632 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8633
8634 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8635 window manager window around the frame. */
8636
8637 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8638
8639 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8640 {
8641 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8642
8643 int adjusted_left;
8644 int adjusted_top;
8645
8646 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8647 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8648 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8649
8650 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8651
8652 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8653 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8654
8655 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8656 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8657
8658 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8659 }
8660 else
8661 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8662 frame's position. */
8663
8664 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8665 }
8666
8667
8668 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8669 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8670 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8671 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8672 of an exact comparison. */
8673
8674 static void
8675 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8676 {
8677 int count = 0;
8678
8679 while (count++ < 50)
8680 {
8681 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8682
8683 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8684 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8685 loop. */
8686
8687 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8688 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8689
8690 if (fuzzy)
8691 {
8692 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8693 pixels. */
8694
8695 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8696 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8697 return;
8698 }
8699 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8700 return;
8701 }
8702
8703 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8704 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8705
8706 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8707 }
8708
8709
8710 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8711 void
8712 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8713 {
8714 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8715
8716 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8717 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8718 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8719
8720 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8721 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8722
8723 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8724 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8725 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8726 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8727 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8728
8729 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8730 {
8731 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8732 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8733 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8734 BLOCK_INPUT;
8735 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8736
8737 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8738 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8739
8740 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8741 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8742
8743 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8744 break; /* Timeout */
8745 }
8746 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8747 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8748 }
8749
8750
8751 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8752 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8753 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8754 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8755
8756 static void
8757 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8758 {
8759 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8760
8761 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8762 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8763 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8764 ? 0
8765 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8766
8767 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8768
8769 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8770 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8771 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8772 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8773
8774 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8775 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8776 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8777 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8778
8779
8780 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8781 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8782 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8783 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8784 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8785
8786 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8787 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8788 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8789 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8790
8791 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8792 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8793 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8794 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8795 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8796
8797 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8798 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8799
8800 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8801 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8802 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8803 if (f->async_visible)
8804 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8805 else
8806 {
8807 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8808 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8809 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8810 x_sync (f);
8811 }
8812 }
8813
8814
8815 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8816 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8817 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8818 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8819
8820 void
8821 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8822 {
8823 BLOCK_INPUT;
8824
8825 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8826 {
8827 int r, c;
8828
8829 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8830 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8831 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8832 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8833 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8834 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8835 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8836 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8837 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8838 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8839 is however. */
8840 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8841 #endif
8842 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8843 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8844 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8845 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8846 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8847 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8848 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8849 }
8850
8851 #ifdef USE_GTK
8852 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8853 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8854 else
8855 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8856 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8857
8858 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8859
8860 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8861
8862 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8863 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8864
8865 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8866 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8867 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8868 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8869 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8870
8871 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8872 }
8873 \f
8874 /* Mouse warping. */
8875
8876 void
8877 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8878 {
8879 int pix_x, pix_y;
8880
8881 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8882 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8883
8884 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8885 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8886
8887 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8888 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8889
8890 BLOCK_INPUT;
8891
8892 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8893 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8894 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8895 }
8896
8897 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8898
8899 void
8900 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8901 {
8902 BLOCK_INPUT;
8903
8904 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8905 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8906 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8907 }
8908 \f
8909 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8910
8911 void
8912 x_focus_on_frame (struct frame *f)
8913 {
8914 #if 0
8915 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8916 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8917 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8918 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8919 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8920 #endif /* ! 0 */
8921 }
8922
8923 void
8924 x_unfocus_frame (struct frame *f)
8925 {
8926 #if 0
8927 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8928 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8929 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8930 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8931 #endif /* ! 0 */
8932 }
8933
8934 /* Raise frame F. */
8935
8936 void
8937 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8938 {
8939 BLOCK_INPUT;
8940 if (f->async_visible)
8941 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8942
8943 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8944 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8945 }
8946
8947 /* Lower frame F. */
8948
8949 void
8950 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8951 {
8952 if (f->async_visible)
8953 {
8954 BLOCK_INPUT;
8955 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8956 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8957 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8958 }
8959 }
8960
8961 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8962
8963 void
8964 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8965 {
8966 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8967 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8968
8969 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8970 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8971 {
8972 Lisp_Object frame;
8973 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8974 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8975 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8976 make_number (32),
8977 Fcons (make_number (1),
8978 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8979 Qnil)));
8980 }
8981 }
8982
8983 static void
8984 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8985 {
8986 if (raise_flag)
8987 x_raise_frame (f);
8988 else
8989 x_lower_frame (f);
8990 }
8991 \f
8992 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8993
8994 void
8995 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8996 {
8997 Atom atom;
8998 unsigned long data[2];
8999 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9000
9001 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9002 data[1] = flags;
9003
9004 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9005 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9006 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9007 }
9008
9009 void
9010 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time time, enum xembed_message message, long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9011 {
9012 XEvent event;
9013
9014 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9015 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9016 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9017 event.xclient.format = 32;
9018 event.xclient.data.l[0] = time;
9019 event.xclient.data.l[1] = message;
9020 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9021 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9022 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9023
9024 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9025 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9026 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9027 }
9028 \f
9029 /* Change of visibility. */
9030
9031 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9032 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9033 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9034 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9035 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9036 finishes with it. */
9037
9038 void
9039 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9040 {
9041 Lisp_Object type;
9042 int original_top, original_left;
9043 int retry_count = 2;
9044
9045 retry:
9046
9047 BLOCK_INPUT;
9048
9049 type = x_icon_type (f);
9050 if (!NILP (type))
9051 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9052
9053 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9054 {
9055 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9056 call x_set_offset a second time
9057 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9058 before the window gets really visible. */
9059 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9060 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9061 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9062 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9063
9064 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9065
9066 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9067 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9068 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9069 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9070 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9071 else
9072 {
9073 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9074 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9075 }
9076 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9077 #ifdef USE_GTK
9078 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9079 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9080 #else
9081 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9082 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9083 else
9084 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9085 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9086 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9087 }
9088
9089 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9090
9091 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9092 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9093 so that incoming events are handled. */
9094 {
9095 Lisp_Object frame;
9096 int count;
9097 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9098 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9099 will set it when they are handled. */
9100 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9101
9102 original_left = f->left_pos;
9103 original_top = f->top_pos;
9104
9105 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9106 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9107
9108 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9109
9110 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9111 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9112 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9113 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9114
9115 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9116 because the window manager may choose the position
9117 and we don't want to override it. */
9118
9119 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9120 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9121 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9122 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9123 && previously_visible)
9124 {
9125 Drawable rootw;
9126 int x, y;
9127 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9128
9129 BLOCK_INPUT;
9130
9131 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9132 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9133 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9134 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9135 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9136 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9137 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9138 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9139 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9140
9141 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9142 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9143 original_left, original_top);
9144
9145 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9146 }
9147
9148 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9149
9150 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9151 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9152 MapNotify at all.. */
9153 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9154 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9155 {
9156 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9157 x_sync (f);
9158
9159 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9160 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9161 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9162 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9163 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9164 probably a bug. */
9165 if (input_polling_used ())
9166 {
9167 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9168 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9169 handler reset it. */
9170 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9171 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9172 poll_for_input_1 ();
9173 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9174 }
9175
9176 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9177 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9178 }
9179
9180 /* 2000-09-28: In
9181
9182 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9183 (iconify-frame f)
9184 (raise-frame f))
9185
9186 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9187 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9188 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9189 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9190
9191 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9192 goto retry;
9193 }
9194 }
9195
9196 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9197
9198 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9199
9200 void
9201 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9202 {
9203 Window window;
9204
9205 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9206 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9207
9208 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9209 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9210 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9211
9212 BLOCK_INPUT;
9213
9214 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9215 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9216 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9217 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9218 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9219 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9220
9221 #ifdef USE_GTK
9222 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9223 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9224 else
9225 #else
9226 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9227 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9228 else
9229 #endif
9230 {
9231
9232 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9233 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9234 {
9235 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9236 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9237 }
9238 }
9239
9240 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9241 just by the event that we get from the server.
9242 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9243 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9244 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9245 f->visible = 0;
9246 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9247 f->async_visible = 0;
9248 f->async_iconified = 0;
9249
9250 x_sync (f);
9251
9252 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9253 }
9254
9255 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9256
9257 void
9258 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9259 {
9260 int result;
9261 Lisp_Object type;
9262
9263 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9264 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9265 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9266
9267 if (f->async_iconified)
9268 return;
9269
9270 BLOCK_INPUT;
9271
9272 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9273
9274 type = x_icon_type (f);
9275 if (!NILP (type))
9276 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9277
9278 #ifdef USE_GTK
9279 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9280 {
9281 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9282 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9283
9284 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9285 f->iconified = 1;
9286 f->visible = 1;
9287 f->async_iconified = 1;
9288 f->async_visible = 0;
9289 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9290 return;
9291 }
9292 #endif
9293
9294 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9295
9296 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9297 {
9298 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9299 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9300 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9301 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9302 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9303 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9304 so we have to record it here. */
9305 f->iconified = 1;
9306 f->visible = 1;
9307 f->async_iconified = 1;
9308 f->async_visible = 0;
9309 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9310 return;
9311 }
9312
9313 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9314 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9315 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9316 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9317
9318 if (!result)
9319 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9320
9321 f->async_iconified = 1;
9322 f->async_visible = 0;
9323
9324
9325 BLOCK_INPUT;
9326 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9327 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9328 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9329
9330 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9331 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9332 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9333 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9334 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9335 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9336
9337 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9338 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9339
9340 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9341 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9342 {
9343 XEvent message;
9344
9345 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9346 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9347 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9348 message.xclient.format = 32;
9349 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9350
9351 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9352 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9353 False,
9354 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9355 &message))
9356 {
9357 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9358 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9359 }
9360 }
9361
9362 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9363 IconicState. */
9364 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9365
9366 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9367 {
9368 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9369 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9370 }
9371
9372 f->async_iconified = 1;
9373 f->async_visible = 0;
9374
9375 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9376 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9377 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9378 }
9379
9380 \f
9381 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9382
9383 void
9384 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9385 {
9386 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9387 Lisp_Object bar;
9388 struct scroll_bar *b;
9389 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9390
9391 BLOCK_INPUT;
9392
9393 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9394 commands to the X server. */
9395 if (dpyinfo->display)
9396 {
9397 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9398 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9399 face. */
9400 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9401 free_frame_faces (f);
9402
9403 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9404 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9405
9406 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9407 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9408 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9409 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9410 toolkit scroll bars. */
9411 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9412 {
9413 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9414 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9415 }
9416 #endif
9417
9418 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9419 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9420 free_frame_xic (f);
9421 #endif
9422
9423 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9424 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9425 {
9426 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9427 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9428 }
9429 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9430 we are using a toolkit. */
9431 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9432 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9433
9434 free_frame_menubar (f);
9435 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9436
9437 #ifdef USE_GTK
9438 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9439 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9440
9441 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9442 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9443 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9444
9445 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9446 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9447 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9448 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9449 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9450 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9451
9452 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9453 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9454 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9455 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9456 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9457 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9458 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9459 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9460 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9461 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9462 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9463 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9464 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9465 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9466 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9467
9468 x_free_gcs (f);
9469 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9470 }
9471
9472 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9473 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9474 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9475
9476 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9477 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9478 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9479 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9480 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9481 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9482
9483 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9484 {
9485 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9486 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9487 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9488 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9489 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9490 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9491 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9492 }
9493
9494 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9495 }
9496
9497
9498 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9499
9500 void
9501 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9502 {
9503 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9504
9505 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9506 commands to the X server. */
9507 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9508 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9509
9510 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9511 }
9512
9513 \f
9514 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9515
9516 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9517 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9518 that the window now has.
9519 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9520 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9521 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9522
9523 #ifndef USE_GTK
9524 void
9525 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9526 {
9527 XSizeHints size_hints;
9528 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9529
9530 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9531 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9532
9533 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9534 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9535
9536 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9537 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9538
9539 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9540 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9541 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9542 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9543 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9544 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9545
9546 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9547 {
9548 int base_width, base_height;
9549 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9550
9551 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9552 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9553
9554 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9555
9556 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9557 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9558 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9559 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9560 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9561
9562 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9563 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9564 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9565
9566 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9567 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9568 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9569 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9570 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9571 }
9572
9573 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9574 if (flags)
9575 {
9576 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9577 goto no_read;
9578 }
9579
9580 {
9581 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9582 long supplied_return;
9583 int value;
9584
9585 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9586 &supplied_return);
9587
9588 if (flags)
9589 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9590 else
9591 {
9592 if (value == 0)
9593 hints.flags = 0;
9594 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9595 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9596 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9597 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9598 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9599 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9600 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9601 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9602 }
9603 }
9604
9605 no_read:
9606
9607 #ifdef PWinGravity
9608 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9609 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9610
9611 if (user_position)
9612 {
9613 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9614 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9615 }
9616 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9617
9618 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9619 }
9620 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9621
9622 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9623
9624 void
9625 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9626 {
9627 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9628 Arg al[1];
9629
9630 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9631 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9632 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9633 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9634
9635 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9636 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9637
9638 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9639 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9640 }
9641
9642 void
9643 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, int pixmap_id)
9644 {
9645 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9646
9647 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9648 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9649 #endif
9650
9651 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9652 {
9653 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9654 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9655 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9656 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9657 }
9658 else
9659 {
9660 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9661 pixmap. */
9662 return;
9663 }
9664
9665
9666 #ifdef USE_GTK
9667 {
9668 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9669 return;
9670 }
9671
9672 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9673
9674 {
9675 Arg al[1];
9676 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9677 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9678 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9679 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9680 }
9681
9682 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9683
9684 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9685 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9686
9687 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9688 }
9689
9690 void
9691 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9692 {
9693 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9694
9695 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9696 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9697 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9698
9699 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9700 }
9701
9702 \f
9703 /***********************************************************************
9704 Fonts
9705 ***********************************************************************/
9706
9707 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9708
9709 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9710 font table. */
9711
9712 static void
9713 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9714 {
9715 Lisp_Object frame;
9716
9717 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9718 if (font->driver->check)
9719 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9720 }
9721
9722 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9723
9724 \f
9725 /***********************************************************************
9726 Initialization
9727 ***********************************************************************/
9728
9729 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9730 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9731 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9732 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9733
9734 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9735 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9736 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9737
9738 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9739 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9740 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9741 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9742 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9743 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9744 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9745 };
9746
9747 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9748
9749 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9750
9751 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9752
9753 static int x_initialized;
9754
9755 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
9756 static int x_session_initialized;
9757 #endif
9758
9759 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9760 the screen number from the server number. */
9761 static int
9762 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9763 {
9764 int seen_colon = 0;
9765 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
9766 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
9767 int length_until_period = 0;
9768
9769 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9770 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9771 length_until_period++;
9772
9773 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9774 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9775 name1 += 4;
9776 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9777 name2 += 4;
9778 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9779 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9780 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9781 name1 += system_name_length;
9782 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9783 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9784 name2 += system_name_length;
9785 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9786 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9787 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9788 name1 += length_until_period;
9789 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9790 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9791 name2 += length_until_period;
9792
9793 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9794 {
9795 if (*name1 == ':')
9796 seen_colon++;
9797 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9798 return 1;
9799 }
9800 return (seen_colon
9801 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9802 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9803 }
9804
9805 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9806 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9807 to 5. */
9808 static void
9809 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9810 {
9811 int nr = 0;
9812 int off = 0;
9813
9814 while (!(mask & 1))
9815 {
9816 off++;
9817 mask >>= 1;
9818 }
9819
9820 while (mask & 1)
9821 {
9822 nr++;
9823 mask >>= 1;
9824 }
9825
9826 *offset = off;
9827 *bits = nr;
9828 }
9829
9830 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9831 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9832
9833 int
9834 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9835 {
9836 int dpy_ok = 1;
9837 Display *dpy;
9838
9839 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9840 if (dpy)
9841 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9842 else
9843 dpy_ok = 0;
9844 return dpy_ok;
9845 }
9846
9847 #ifdef USE_GTK
9848 static void
9849 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level, const gchar *message, gpointer user_data)
9850 {
9851 if (!strstr (message, "g_set_prgname"))
9852 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, message);
9853 }
9854 #endif
9855
9856 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9857 the structure that describes the open display.
9858 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9859
9860 struct x_display_info *
9861 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9862 {
9863 int connection;
9864 Display *dpy;
9865 struct terminal *terminal;
9866 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9867 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9868 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9869
9870 BLOCK_INPUT;
9871
9872 if (!x_initialized)
9873 {
9874 x_initialize ();
9875 ++x_initialized;
9876 }
9877
9878 if (! x_display_ok (SDATA (display_name)))
9879 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SDATA (display_name));
9880
9881 #ifdef USE_GTK
9882 {
9883 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9884 int argc;
9885 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9886 char **argv2 = argv;
9887 guint id;
9888
9889 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9890 {
9891 xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9892 }
9893 else
9894 {
9895 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9896 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9897
9898 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9899 argv[argc] = 0;
9900
9901 argc = 0;
9902 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9903
9904 if (! NILP (display_name))
9905 {
9906 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9907 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
9908 }
9909
9910 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9911 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9912
9913 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9914
9915 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9916 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9917 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9918 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9919 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9920 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9921
9922 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9923 fixup_locale ();
9924 xg_initialize ();
9925
9926 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
9927
9928 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9929 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9930
9931 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9932 {
9933 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9934 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9935
9936 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9937 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9938
9939 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9940 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
9941 }
9942
9943 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9944 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9945 }
9946 }
9947 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9948 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9949 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9950 errors with X11R5:
9951 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9952 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9953 So let's not use it until R6. */
9954 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9955 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9956 #endif
9957
9958 {
9959 int argc = 0;
9960 char *argv[3];
9961
9962 argv[0] = "";
9963 argc = 1;
9964 if (xrm_option)
9965 {
9966 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9967 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9968 }
9969 turn_on_atimers (0);
9970 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
9971 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9972 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9973 &argc, argv);
9974 turn_on_atimers (1);
9975
9976 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9977 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9978 fixup_locale ();
9979 #endif
9980 }
9981
9982 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9983 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9984 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
9985 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9986 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9987
9988 /* Detect failure. */
9989 if (dpy == 0)
9990 {
9991 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9992 return 0;
9993 }
9994
9995 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9996
9997 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
9998 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
9999 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10000
10001 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10002
10003 {
10004 struct x_display_info *share;
10005 Lisp_Object tail;
10006
10007 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10008 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10009 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10010 SDATA (display_name)))
10011 break;
10012 if (share)
10013 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10014 else
10015 {
10016 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10017 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10018 terminal->kboard->Vwindow_system = Qx;
10019
10020 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10021 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10022 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10023 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10024 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10025
10026 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10027 {
10028 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10029
10030 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10031 list of terminals. */
10032 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10033 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10034 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10035 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10036
10037 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10038 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10039 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10040 terminal->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10041 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10042 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10043 BLOCK_INPUT;
10044 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10045 terminal_list = terminal;
10046 UNGCPRO;
10047 }
10048
10049 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10050 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10051 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10052 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10053 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10054 }
10055 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10056 }
10057
10058 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10059 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10060 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10061
10062 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10063 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10064 x_display_name_list);
10065 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10066
10067 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10068
10069 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10070 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10071 strncpy (terminal->name, SDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10072 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10073
10074 #if 0
10075 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10076 #endif /* ! 0 */
10077
10078 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10079 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10080 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10081 + 2);
10082 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10083 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10084
10085 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10086 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10087
10088 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10089 #ifdef USE_GTK
10090 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10091 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10092 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10093
10094 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10095 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10096
10097 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10098 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10099 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10100 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10101 #else
10102 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10103 #endif
10104 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10105 all versions. */
10106 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10107
10108 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10109 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10110 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10111 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10112 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10113 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10114 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10115 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10116 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10117 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10118 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10119 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10120 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10121 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10122 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10123 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10124 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10125 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10126 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10127 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10128 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10129 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10130 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10131 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10132 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10133 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10134 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10135 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10136
10137 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10138 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10139 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10140
10141 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10142 {
10143 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10144 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10145 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10146 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10147 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10148 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10149 }
10150
10151 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10152 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10153 {
10154 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10155 {
10156 Lisp_Object value;
10157 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10158 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10159 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10160 Qnil, Qnil);
10161 if (STRINGP (value)
10162 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10163 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10164 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10165 }
10166 }
10167 else
10168 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10169 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10170
10171 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10172 {
10173 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10174 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10175 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10176 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10177 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10178 for example). */
10179 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10180 double d;
10181 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10182 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10183 }
10184 #endif
10185
10186 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10187 {
10188 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10189 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10190 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10191 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10192 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10193 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10194 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10195 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10196 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10197 }
10198
10199 {
10200 const struct
10201 {
10202 const char *name;
10203 Atom *atom;
10204 } atom_refs[] = {
10205 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10206 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10207 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10208 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10209 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10210 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10211 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10212 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10213 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10214 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10215 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10216 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10217 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10218 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10219 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10220 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10221 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10222 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10223 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10224 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10225 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10226 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10227 /* For properties of font. */
10228 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10229 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10230 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10231 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10232 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10233 /* Ghostscript support. */
10234 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10235 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10236 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10237 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10238 /* EWMH */
10239 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10240 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10241 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10242 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10243 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10244 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10245 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10246 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10247 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10248 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10249 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10250 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10251 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10252 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10253 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10254 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10255 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10256 /* Session management */
10257 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10258 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10259 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10260 };
10261
10262 int i;
10263 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10264 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10265 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10266 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (sizeof (Atom) * total_atom_count);
10267 char **atom_names = xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count);
10268 char xsettings_atom_name[64];
10269
10270 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10271 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10272
10273 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10274 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name),
10275 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10276 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10277
10278 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10279 False, atoms_return);
10280
10281 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10282 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10283
10284 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10285 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10286
10287 xfree (atom_names);
10288 xfree (atoms_return);
10289 }
10290
10291 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10292 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10293 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10294 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10295
10296 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10297 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10298 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10299
10300 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10301 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10302
10303 {
10304 dpyinfo->gray
10305 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10306 gray_bitmap_bits,
10307 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10308 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10309 }
10310
10311 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10312 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10313 #endif
10314
10315 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10316
10317 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10318 if (connection != 0)
10319 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10320
10321 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10322 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10323 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10324
10325 #ifdef SIGIO
10326 if (interrupt_input)
10327 init_sigio (connection);
10328 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10329
10330 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10331 {
10332 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10333 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10334 Font font;
10335
10336 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10337 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10338 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10339 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10340 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10341 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10342 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10343 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10344 abort ();
10345 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10346 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10347 x_uncatch_errors ();
10348 }
10349 #endif
10350
10351 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10352 for debugging X code. */
10353 {
10354 Lisp_Object value;
10355 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10356 build_string ("synchronous"),
10357 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10358 Qnil, Qnil);
10359 if (STRINGP (value)
10360 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10361 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10362 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10363 }
10364
10365 {
10366 Lisp_Object value;
10367 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10368 build_string ("useXIM"),
10369 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10370 Qnil, Qnil);
10371 #ifdef USE_XIM
10372 if (STRINGP (value)
10373 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "false")
10374 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "off")))
10375 use_xim = 0;
10376 #else
10377 if (STRINGP (value)
10378 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10379 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10380 use_xim = 1;
10381 #endif
10382 }
10383
10384 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10385 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10386 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10387 tty. */
10388 if (terminal->id == 1)
10389 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10390 #endif
10391
10392 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10393
10394 return dpyinfo;
10395 }
10396 \f
10397 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10398 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10399
10400 void
10401 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10402 {
10403 struct terminal *t;
10404
10405 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10406 X display. */
10407 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10408 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10409 {
10410 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10411 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10412 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10413 x_session_close ();
10414 #endif
10415 delete_terminal (t);
10416 break;
10417 }
10418
10419 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10420
10421 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10422 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10423 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10424 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10425 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10426 else
10427 {
10428 Lisp_Object tail;
10429
10430 tail = x_display_name_list;
10431 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10432 {
10433 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10434 {
10435 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10436 break;
10437 }
10438 tail = XCDR (tail);
10439 }
10440 }
10441
10442 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10443 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10444
10445 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10446 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10447 else
10448 {
10449 struct x_display_info *tail;
10450
10451 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10452 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10453 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10454 }
10455
10456 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10457 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10458 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10459 xfree (dpyinfo);
10460 }
10461
10462 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10463
10464 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10465 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10466 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10467 that slows us down. */
10468
10469 static void
10470 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10471 {
10472 BLOCK_INPUT;
10473 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10474 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10475 {
10476 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10477 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10478 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10479 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10480 }
10481 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10482 }
10483
10484 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10485 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10486 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10487 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10488 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10489 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10490 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10491
10492 void
10493 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10494 {
10495 BLOCK_INPUT;
10496 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10497 {
10498 EMACS_TIME interval;
10499
10500 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10501 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10502 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10503 }
10504 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10505 }
10506
10507 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10508
10509 \f
10510 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10511
10512 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10513
10514 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10515 {
10516 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10517 x_produce_glyphs,
10518 x_write_glyphs,
10519 x_insert_glyphs,
10520 x_clear_end_of_line,
10521 x_scroll_run,
10522 x_after_update_window_line,
10523 x_update_window_begin,
10524 x_update_window_end,
10525 x_cursor_to,
10526 x_flush,
10527 #ifdef XFlush
10528 x_flush,
10529 #else
10530 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10531 #endif
10532 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10533 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10534 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10535 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10536 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10537 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10538 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10539 x_draw_glyph_string,
10540 x_define_frame_cursor,
10541 x_clear_frame_area,
10542 x_draw_window_cursor,
10543 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10544 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10545 };
10546
10547
10548 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10549 void
10550 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10551 {
10552 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10553
10554 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10555 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10556 if (!terminal->name)
10557 return;
10558
10559 BLOCK_INPUT;
10560 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10561 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10562 X display. */
10563 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10564 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10565 #endif
10566
10567 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10568 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10569 if (dpyinfo->display)
10570 {
10571 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10572 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10573
10574 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10575 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10576 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10577 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10578
10579 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10580 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10581 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10582 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10583 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10584 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10585 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10586 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10587 leaks in other situations. */
10588 #if 0
10589 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10590 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10591 #else
10592 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10593 #endif
10594 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10595 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10596 closing all the displays. */
10597 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10598 #endif
10599
10600 #ifdef USE_GTK
10601 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10602 #else
10603 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10604 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10605 #else
10606 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10607 #endif
10608 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10609 }
10610
10611 /* Mark as dead. */
10612 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10613 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10614 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10615 }
10616
10617 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10618 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10619
10620 static struct terminal *
10621 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10622 {
10623 struct terminal *terminal;
10624
10625 terminal = create_terminal ();
10626
10627 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10628 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10629 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10630
10631 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10632
10633 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10634 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10635 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10636 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10637 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10638 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10639 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10640 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10641 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10642 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10643 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10644 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10645 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10646 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10647 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10648 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10649 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10650 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10651 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10652 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10653
10654 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10655 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10656
10657 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10658 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10659 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10660 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10661 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10662 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10663 off the bottom. */
10664
10665 return terminal;
10666 }
10667
10668 void
10669 x_initialize (void)
10670 {
10671 baud_rate = 19200;
10672
10673 x_noop_count = 0;
10674 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10675 any_help_event_p = 0;
10676 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10677 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10678 x_session_initialized = 0;
10679 #endif
10680
10681 #ifdef USE_GTK
10682 current_count = -1;
10683 #endif
10684
10685 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10686 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10687
10688 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10689 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10690
10691 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10692
10693 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10694 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10695 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10696 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10697 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10698 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10699 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10700
10701 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10702 #endif
10703
10704 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10705 #ifndef USE_GTK
10706 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10707 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10708 #endif
10709 #endif
10710
10711 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10712 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10713 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10714
10715 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10716 original error handler. */
10717 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10718 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10719
10720 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10721
10722 xgselect_initialize ();
10723 }
10724
10725
10726 void
10727 syms_of_xterm (void)
10728 {
10729 x_error_message = NULL;
10730
10731 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10732 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10733
10734 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10735 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10736
10737 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10738 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern_c_string ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10739
10740 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10741 Qlatin_1 = intern_c_string ("latin-1");
10742
10743 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10744 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10745
10746 #ifdef USE_GTK
10747 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10748 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10749
10750 Qx_gtk_map_stock = intern_c_string ("x-gtk-map-stock");
10751 staticpro (&Qx_gtk_map_stock);
10752 #endif
10753
10754 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10755 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10756 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10757 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10758 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10759 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10760 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10761 sizes. */);
10762 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10763
10764 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10765 &x_underline_at_descent_line,
10766 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10767 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10768 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10769 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10770 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10771
10772 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10773 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10774 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10775 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10776 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10777 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10778 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10779 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10780 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10781
10782 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10783 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10784 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10785 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10786 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10787 With MS Windows, the value is t. */);
10788 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10789 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10790 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10791 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10792 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10793 #elif USE_GTK
10794 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10795 #else
10796 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10797 #endif
10798 #else
10799 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10800 #endif
10801
10802 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10803 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10804
10805 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10806 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10807 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10808 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10809 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10810 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10811 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10812 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10813 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10814
10815 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10816 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10817 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10818 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10819 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10820 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10821
10822 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10823 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10824 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10825 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10826 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10827 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10828
10829 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10830 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10831 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10832 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10833 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10834 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10835
10836 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10837 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10838 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10839 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10840 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10841 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10842
10843 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10844 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10845 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10846 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10847 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10848 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10849 }
10850
10851 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10852